(init_image) [MAC_OS]: Don't call EnterMovies if
[emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
blob74fdd37536411e7aa4795f71d6dedeb559b59d8e
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
3 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
7 GNU Emacs is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
10 any later version.
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs; see the file COPYING. If not, write to
19 the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
20 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. */
22 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
23 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
25 #include <config.h>
27 /* On 4.3 these lose if they come after xterm.h. */
28 /* Putting these at the beginning seems to be standard for other .c files. */
29 #include <signal.h>
31 #include <stdio.h>
33 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
35 #include "lisp.h"
36 #include "blockinput.h"
38 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
39 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
40 #include "syssignal.h"
42 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
43 if this is not done before the other system files. */
44 #include "xterm.h"
45 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
47 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
48 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
49 #ifndef makedev
50 #include <sys/types.h>
51 #endif /* makedev */
53 #ifdef BSD_SYSTEM
54 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
55 #endif /* ! defined (BSD_SYSTEM) */
57 #include "systty.h"
58 #include "systime.h"
60 #ifndef INCLUDED_FCNTL
61 #include <fcntl.h>
62 #endif
63 #include <ctype.h>
64 #include <errno.h>
65 #include <setjmp.h>
66 #include <sys/stat.h>
67 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
68 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
70 #include "charset.h"
71 #include "coding.h"
72 #include "ccl.h"
73 #include "frame.h"
74 #include "dispextern.h"
75 #include "fontset.h"
76 #include "termhooks.h"
77 #include "termopts.h"
78 #include "termchar.h"
79 #include "gnu.h"
80 #include "disptab.h"
81 #include "buffer.h"
82 #include "window.h"
83 #include "keyboard.h"
84 #include "intervals.h"
85 #include "process.h"
86 #include "atimer.h"
87 #include "keymap.h"
89 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
90 #include <X11/Shell.h>
91 #endif
93 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
94 #include <sys/time.h>
95 #endif
96 #ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
97 #include <unistd.h>
98 #endif
100 #ifdef USE_GTK
101 #include "gtkutil.h"
102 #endif
104 #ifdef USE_LUCID
105 extern int xlwmenu_window_p P_ ((Widget w, Window window));
106 extern void xlwmenu_redisplay P_ ((Widget));
107 #endif
109 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
111 extern void free_frame_menubar P_ ((struct frame *));
112 extern struct frame *x_menubar_window_to_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
113 int));
114 #endif
116 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
117 #if (XtSpecificationRelease >= 5) && !defined(NO_EDITRES)
118 #define HACK_EDITRES
119 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages ();
120 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
122 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
124 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
125 #if defined USE_MOTIF
126 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
127 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
128 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
130 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
131 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
132 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
133 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
134 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
135 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
136 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
137 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
138 #ifndef XtNpickTop
139 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
140 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
141 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
142 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
144 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
146 #if ! defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) && ! defined (USE_GTK)
147 #define x_any_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
148 #define x_top_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
149 #endif
151 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
152 #include "widget.h"
153 #ifndef XtNinitialState
154 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
155 #endif
156 #endif
158 #define abs(x) ((x) < 0 ? -(x) : (x))
160 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
161 #ifdef USE_XIM
162 int use_xim = 1;
163 #else
164 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
165 #endif
169 /* Non-nil means Emacs uses toolkit scroll bars. */
171 Lisp_Object Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars;
173 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
174 start. */
176 static int any_help_event_p;
178 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
179 static Lisp_Object last_window;
181 /* Non-zero means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties. */
183 int x_use_underline_position_properties;
185 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
186 use. */
188 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
190 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
191 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
192 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
193 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
195 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
197 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
198 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
199 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
200 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
202 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
204 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
206 struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
208 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
209 /* The application context for Xt use. */
210 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
211 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
212 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
214 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
216 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
218 /* Non-zero means to not move point as a result of clicking on a
219 frame to focus it (when focus-follows-mouse is nil). */
221 int x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position;
223 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
224 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
225 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
227 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
229 /* Mouse movement.
231 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
232 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
233 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
234 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
236 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
238 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
239 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
240 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
241 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
242 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
243 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
244 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
245 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
246 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
247 is off. */
249 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
251 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
252 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame;
253 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
255 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
257 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
258 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
259 an ordinary motion.
261 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
262 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
263 event. */
265 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
267 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
268 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
269 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
270 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
271 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
272 it's somewhat accurate. */
274 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
276 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
277 events. */
279 #ifdef __STDC__
280 static int volatile input_signal_count;
281 #else
282 static int input_signal_count;
283 #endif
285 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
287 static int x_noop_count;
289 /* Initial values of argv and argc. */
291 extern char **initial_argv;
292 extern int initial_argc;
294 extern Lisp_Object Vcommand_line_args, Vsystem_name;
296 /* Tells if a window manager is present or not. */
298 extern Lisp_Object Vx_no_window_manager;
300 extern Lisp_Object Qeql;
302 extern int errno;
304 /* A mask of extra modifier bits to put into every keyboard char. */
306 extern EMACS_INT extra_keyboard_modifiers;
308 /* The keysyms to use for the various modifiers. */
310 Lisp_Object Vx_alt_keysym, Vx_hyper_keysym, Vx_meta_keysym, Vx_super_keysym;
311 Lisp_Object Vx_keysym_table;
312 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
314 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
315 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
317 extern XrmDatabase x_load_resources P_ ((Display *, char *, char *, char *));
318 extern int x_bitmap_mask P_ ((FRAME_PTR, int));
320 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 P_ ((Display *, Colormap, XColor *));
321 static void x_set_window_size_1 P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
322 static const XColor *x_color_cells P_ ((Display *, int *));
323 static void x_update_window_end P_ ((struct window *, int, int));
324 void x_delete_display P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
325 static unsigned int x_x_to_emacs_modifiers P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
326 unsigned));
327 static int x_io_error_quitter P_ ((Display *));
328 int x_catch_errors P_ ((Display *));
329 void x_uncatch_errors P_ ((Display *, int));
330 void x_lower_frame P_ ((struct frame *));
331 void x_scroll_bar_clear P_ ((struct frame *));
332 int x_had_errors_p P_ ((Display *));
333 void x_wm_set_size_hint P_ ((struct frame *, long, int));
334 void x_raise_frame P_ ((struct frame *));
335 void x_set_window_size P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
336 void x_wm_set_window_state P_ ((struct frame *, int));
337 void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap P_ ((struct frame *, int));
338 void x_initialize P_ ((void));
339 static void x_font_min_bounds P_ ((XFontStruct *, int *, int *));
340 static int x_compute_min_glyph_bounds P_ ((struct frame *));
341 static void x_update_end P_ ((struct frame *));
342 static void XTframe_up_to_date P_ ((struct frame *));
343 static void XTset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
344 static void XTreset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
345 static void x_clear_frame P_ ((void));
346 static void frame_highlight P_ ((struct frame *));
347 static void frame_unhighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
348 static void x_new_focus_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *, struct frame *));
349 static void x_focus_changed P_ ((int, int, struct x_display_info *,
350 struct frame *, struct input_event *));
351 static void x_detect_focus_change P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
352 XEvent *, struct input_event *));
353 static void XTframe_rehighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
354 static void x_frame_rehighlight P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
355 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *));
356 static void x_draw_bar_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
357 enum text_cursor_kinds));
359 static void x_clip_to_row P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC));
360 static void x_flush P_ ((struct frame *f));
361 static void x_update_begin P_ ((struct frame *));
362 static void x_update_window_begin P_ ((struct window *));
363 static void x_after_update_window_line P_ ((struct glyph_row *));
364 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar P_ ((Display *, Window));
365 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion P_ ((struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
366 enum scroll_bar_part *,
367 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
368 unsigned long *));
369 static void x_check_fullscreen P_ ((struct frame *));
370 static void x_check_expected_move P_ ((struct frame *));
371 static int handle_one_xevent P_ ((struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
372 int *, struct input_event *));
375 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
377 static void
378 x_flush (f)
379 struct frame *f;
381 BLOCK_INPUT;
382 if (f == NULL)
384 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
385 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
386 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
388 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
389 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
390 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
394 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
395 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
396 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
397 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
398 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
399 performance. */
401 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
404 /***********************************************************************
405 Debugging
406 ***********************************************************************/
408 #if 0
410 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
411 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
413 struct record
415 char *locus;
416 int type;
419 struct record event_record[100];
421 int event_record_index;
423 record_event (locus, type)
424 char *locus;
425 int type;
427 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
428 event_record_index = 0;
430 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
431 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
432 event_record_index++;
435 #endif /* 0 */
439 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
441 struct x_display_info *
442 x_display_info_for_display (dpy)
443 Display *dpy;
445 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
447 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
448 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
449 return dpyinfo;
451 return 0;
456 /***********************************************************************
457 Starting and ending an update
458 ***********************************************************************/
460 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
461 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
462 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
463 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
464 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
466 static void
467 x_update_begin (f)
468 struct frame *f;
470 /* Nothing to do. */
474 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
475 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
476 position of W. */
478 static void
479 x_update_window_begin (w)
480 struct window *w;
482 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
483 struct x_display_info *display_info = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
485 updated_window = w;
486 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
488 BLOCK_INPUT;
490 if (f == display_info->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
492 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
493 display_info->mouse_face_defer = 1;
495 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
496 highlighting. */
497 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
498 display_info->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
500 #if 0 /* Rows in a current matrix containing glyphs in mouse-face have
501 their mouse_face_p flag set, which means that they are always
502 unequal to rows in a desired matrix which never have that
503 flag set. So, rows containing mouse-face glyphs are never
504 scrolled, and we don't have to switch the mouse highlight off
505 here to prevent it from being scrolled. */
507 /* Can we tell that this update does not affect the window
508 where the mouse highlight is? If so, no need to turn off.
509 Likewise, don't do anything if the frame is garbaged;
510 in that case, the frame's current matrix that we would use
511 is all wrong, and we will redisplay that line anyway. */
512 if (!NILP (display_info->mouse_face_window)
513 && w == XWINDOW (display_info->mouse_face_window))
515 int i;
517 for (i = 0; i < w->desired_matrix->nrows; ++i)
518 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (w->desired_matrix, i))
519 break;
521 if (i < w->desired_matrix->nrows)
522 clear_mouse_face (display_info);
524 #endif /* 0 */
527 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
531 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
533 static void
534 x_draw_vertical_window_border (w, x, y0, y1)
535 struct window *w;
536 int x, y0, y1;
538 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
539 struct face *face;
541 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
542 if (face)
543 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
544 face->foreground);
546 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
547 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
550 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
552 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
553 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
555 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
556 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
557 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
559 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
560 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
561 here. */
563 static void
564 x_update_window_end (w, cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p)
565 struct window *w;
566 int cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p;
568 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
570 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
572 BLOCK_INPUT;
574 if (cursor_on_p)
575 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
576 output_cursor.vpos,
577 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
579 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
580 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
582 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
585 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
586 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
587 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
589 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
590 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
591 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
594 updated_window = NULL;
598 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
599 update_end. */
601 static void
602 x_update_end (f)
603 struct frame *f;
605 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
606 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
608 #ifndef XFlush
609 BLOCK_INPUT;
610 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
611 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
612 #endif
616 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
617 complete update has been performed. The global variable
618 updated_window is not available here. */
620 static void
621 XTframe_up_to_date (f)
622 struct frame *f;
624 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
626 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
628 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
629 || f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
631 BLOCK_INPUT;
632 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
633 note_mouse_highlight (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
634 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
635 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
636 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
637 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
643 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
644 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
645 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
646 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
647 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
648 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
650 static void
651 x_after_update_window_line (desired_row)
652 struct glyph_row *desired_row;
654 struct window *w = updated_window;
655 struct frame *f;
656 int width, height;
658 xassert (w);
660 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
661 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
663 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
664 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
665 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
666 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
667 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
668 overhead is very small. */
669 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
670 && desired_row->full_width_p
671 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
672 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
673 width != 0)
674 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
675 height > 0))
677 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
679 /* Internal border is drawn below the tool bar. */
680 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
681 && w == XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window))
682 y -= width;
684 BLOCK_INPUT;
685 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
686 0, y, width, height, False);
687 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
688 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
689 y, width, height, False);
690 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
694 static void
695 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (w, row, p)
696 struct window *w;
697 struct glyph_row *row;
698 struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p;
700 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
701 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
702 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
703 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
704 struct face *face = p->face;
705 int rowY;
707 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
708 rowY = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
709 if (p->y < rowY)
711 /* Adjust position of "bottom aligned" bitmap on partially
712 visible last row. */
713 int oldY = row->y;
714 int oldVH = row->visible_height;
715 row->visible_height = p->h;
716 row->y -= rowY - p->y;
717 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
718 row->y = oldY;
719 row->visible_height = oldVH;
721 else
722 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
724 if (p->bx >= 0 && !p->overlay_p)
726 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
727 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
728 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
729 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
730 if (face->stipple)
731 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
732 else
733 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
735 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc,
736 p->bx, p->by, p->nx, p->ny);
738 if (!face->stipple)
739 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
742 if (p->which)
744 unsigned char *bits;
745 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
746 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
747 XGCValues gcv;
749 if (p->wd > 8)
750 bits = (unsigned char *)(p->bits + p->dh);
751 else
752 bits = (unsigned char *)p->bits + p->dh;
754 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
755 by the server. */
756 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
757 (p->cursor_p
758 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
759 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
760 : face->foreground),
761 face->background, depth);
763 if (p->overlay_p)
765 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
766 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
767 bits, p->wd, p->h,
768 1, 0, 1);
769 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
770 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
771 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
772 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
775 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
776 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
777 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
779 if (p->overlay_p)
781 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
782 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
783 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
787 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
792 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
793 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
794 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
795 rarely happens). */
797 static void
798 XTset_terminal_modes ()
802 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
803 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
805 static void
806 XTreset_terminal_modes ()
812 /***********************************************************************
813 Display Iterator
814 ***********************************************************************/
816 /* Function prototypes of this page. */
818 static int x_encode_char P_ ((int, XChar2b *, struct font_info *, int *));
821 /* Get metrics of character CHAR2B in FONT. Value is null if CHAR2B
822 is not contained in the font. */
824 static XCharStruct *
825 x_per_char_metric (font, char2b, font_type)
826 XFontStruct *font;
827 XChar2b *char2b;
828 int font_type; /* unused on X */
830 /* The result metric information. */
831 XCharStruct *pcm = NULL;
833 xassert (font && char2b);
835 if (font->per_char != NULL)
837 if (font->min_byte1 == 0 && font->max_byte1 == 0)
839 /* min_char_or_byte2 specifies the linear character index
840 corresponding to the first element of the per_char array,
841 max_char_or_byte2 is the index of the last character. A
842 character with non-zero CHAR2B->byte1 is not in the font.
843 A character with byte2 less than min_char_or_byte2 or
844 greater max_char_or_byte2 is not in the font. */
845 if (char2b->byte1 == 0
846 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
847 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
848 pcm = font->per_char + char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2;
850 else
852 /* If either min_byte1 or max_byte1 are nonzero, both
853 min_char_or_byte2 and max_char_or_byte2 are less than
854 256, and the 2-byte character index values corresponding
855 to the per_char array element N (counting from 0) are:
857 byte1 = N/D + min_byte1
858 byte2 = N\D + min_char_or_byte2
860 where:
862 D = max_char_or_byte2 - min_char_or_byte2 + 1
863 / = integer division
864 \ = integer modulus */
865 if (char2b->byte1 >= font->min_byte1
866 && char2b->byte1 <= font->max_byte1
867 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
868 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
870 pcm = (font->per_char
871 + ((font->max_char_or_byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2 + 1)
872 * (char2b->byte1 - font->min_byte1))
873 + (char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2));
877 else
879 /* If the per_char pointer is null, all glyphs between the first
880 and last character indexes inclusive have the same
881 information, as given by both min_bounds and max_bounds. */
882 if (char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
883 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
884 pcm = &font->max_bounds;
887 return ((pcm == NULL
888 || (pcm->width == 0 && (pcm->rbearing - pcm->lbearing) == 0))
889 ? NULL : pcm);
893 /* Encode CHAR2B using encoding information from FONT_INFO. CHAR2B is
894 the two-byte form of C. Encoding is returned in *CHAR2B. */
896 static int
897 x_encode_char (c, char2b, font_info, two_byte_p)
898 int c;
899 XChar2b *char2b;
900 struct font_info *font_info;
901 int *two_byte_p;
903 int charset = CHAR_CHARSET (c);
904 XFontStruct *font = font_info->font;
906 /* FONT_INFO may define a scheme by which to encode byte1 and byte2.
907 This may be either a program in a special encoder language or a
908 fixed encoding. */
909 if (font_info->font_encoder)
911 /* It's a program. */
912 struct ccl_program *ccl = font_info->font_encoder;
914 check_ccl_update (ccl);
915 if (CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 1)
917 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
918 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte2;
919 ccl->reg[2] = -1;
921 else
923 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
924 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte1;
925 ccl->reg[2] = char2b->byte2;
928 ccl_driver (ccl, NULL, NULL, 0, 0, NULL);
930 /* We assume that MSBs are appropriately set/reset by CCL
931 program. */
932 if (font->max_byte1 == 0) /* 1-byte font */
933 char2b->byte1 = 0, char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[1];
934 else
935 char2b->byte1 = ccl->reg[1], char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[2];
937 else if (font_info->encoding[charset])
939 /* Fixed encoding scheme. See fontset.h for the meaning of the
940 encoding numbers. */
941 int enc = font_info->encoding[charset];
943 if ((enc == 1 || enc == 2)
944 && CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 2)
945 char2b->byte1 |= 0x80;
947 if (enc == 1 || enc == 3)
948 char2b->byte2 |= 0x80;
951 if (two_byte_p)
952 *two_byte_p = ((XFontStruct *) (font_info->font))->max_byte1 > 0;
954 return FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
959 /***********************************************************************
960 Glyph display
961 ***********************************************************************/
965 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
966 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
967 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background P_ ((struct glyph_string *,
968 int));
969 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
970 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
971 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
972 static void x_draw_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
973 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
974 static void x_set_cursor_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
975 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
976 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
977 static int x_alloc_lighter_color P_ ((struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
978 unsigned long *, double, int));
979 static void x_setup_relief_color P_ ((struct frame *, struct relief *,
980 double, int, unsigned long));
981 static void x_setup_relief_colors P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
982 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
983 static void x_draw_image_relief P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
984 static void x_draw_image_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
985 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 P_ ((struct glyph_string *, Pixmap));
986 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int,
987 int, int, int));
988 static void x_draw_relief_rect P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
989 int, int, int, int, int, int,
990 XRectangle *));
991 static void x_draw_box_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
992 int, int, int, XRectangle *));
994 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
995 static void x_check_font P_ ((struct frame *, XFontStruct *));
996 #endif
999 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
1000 face. */
1002 static void
1003 x_set_cursor_gc (s)
1004 struct glyph_string *s;
1006 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
1007 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
1008 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
1009 && !s->cmp)
1010 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
1011 else
1013 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
1014 XGCValues xgcv;
1015 unsigned long mask;
1017 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
1018 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
1020 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
1021 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1022 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1023 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1024 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
1025 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1026 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1028 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
1029 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
1030 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
1032 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
1033 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
1036 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
1037 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
1038 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1039 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
1041 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1042 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1043 mask, &xgcv);
1044 else
1045 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1046 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1048 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1053 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
1055 static void
1056 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s)
1057 struct glyph_string *s;
1059 int face_id;
1060 struct face *face;
1062 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
1063 face_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
1064 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1065 if (face == NULL)
1066 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
1068 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1069 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch);
1070 else
1071 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0);
1072 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1073 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1075 /* If font in this face is same as S->font, use it. */
1076 if (s->font == s->face->font)
1077 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1078 else
1080 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
1081 but font FONT. */
1082 XGCValues xgcv;
1083 unsigned long mask;
1085 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
1086 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1087 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
1088 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
1089 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1090 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
1092 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1093 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1094 mask, &xgcv);
1095 else
1096 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1097 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1099 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1102 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1106 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1107 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1108 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1110 static INLINE void
1111 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s)
1112 struct glyph_string *s;
1114 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1118 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1119 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1120 pattern. */
1122 static INLINE void
1123 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s)
1124 struct glyph_string *s;
1126 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1128 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1130 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1131 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1133 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1135 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1136 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1138 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1140 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1141 s->stippled_p = 0;
1143 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1145 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1146 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1148 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1149 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1151 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1152 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1154 else
1156 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1157 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1160 /* GC must have been set. */
1161 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1165 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1166 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1168 static INLINE void
1169 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s)
1170 struct glyph_string *s;
1172 XRectangle r;
1173 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
1174 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1178 /* RIF:
1179 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. If S is a glyph
1180 string for a composition, assume overhangs don't exist. */
1182 static void
1183 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s)
1184 struct glyph_string *s;
1186 if (s->cmp == NULL
1187 && s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1189 XCharStruct cs;
1190 int direction, font_ascent, font_descent;
1191 XTextExtents16 (s->font, s->char2b, s->nchars, &direction,
1192 &font_ascent, &font_descent, &cs);
1193 s->right_overhang = cs.rbearing > cs.width ? cs.rbearing - cs.width : 0;
1194 s->left_overhang = cs.lbearing < 0 ? -cs.lbearing : 0;
1199 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1201 static INLINE void
1202 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
1203 struct glyph_string *s;
1204 int x, y, w, h;
1206 XGCValues xgcv;
1207 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1208 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1209 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1210 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1214 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1215 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1216 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1217 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1218 contains the first component of a composition. */
1220 static void
1221 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, force_p)
1222 struct glyph_string *s;
1223 int force_p;
1225 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1226 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1227 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1229 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1231 if (s->stippled_p)
1233 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1234 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1235 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1236 s->y + box_line_width,
1237 s->background_width,
1238 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1239 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1240 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1242 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1243 || s->font_not_found_p
1244 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1245 || force_p)
1247 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1248 s->background_width,
1249 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1250 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1256 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1258 static void
1259 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1260 struct glyph_string *s;
1262 int i, x;
1264 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1265 of S to the right of that box line. */
1266 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1267 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1268 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
1269 else
1270 x = s->x;
1272 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1273 loaded. */
1274 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1276 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1278 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1279 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1280 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1281 s->height - 1);
1282 x += g->pixel_width;
1285 else
1287 char *char1b = (char *) s->char2b;
1288 int boff = s->font_info->baseline_offset;
1290 if (s->font_info->vertical_centering)
1291 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (s->font, s->f) - boff;
1293 /* If we can use 8-bit functions, condense S->char2b. */
1294 if (!s->two_byte_p)
1295 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1296 char1b[i] = s->char2b[i].byte2;
1298 /* Draw text with XDrawString if background has already been
1299 filled. Otherwise, use XDrawImageString. (Note that
1300 XDrawImageString is usually faster than XDrawString.) Always
1301 use XDrawImageString when drawing the cursor so that there is
1302 no chance that characters under a box cursor are invisible. */
1303 if (s->for_overlaps
1304 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1306 /* Draw characters with 16-bit or 8-bit functions. */
1307 if (s->two_byte_p)
1308 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1309 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1310 else
1311 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1312 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1314 else
1316 if (s->two_byte_p)
1317 XDrawImageString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1318 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1319 else
1320 XDrawImageString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1321 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1324 if (s->face->overstrike)
1326 /* For overstriking (to simulate bold-face), draw the
1327 characters again shifted to the right by one pixel. */
1328 if (s->two_byte_p)
1329 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x + 1,
1330 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1331 else
1332 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x + 1,
1333 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1338 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1340 static void
1341 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1342 struct glyph_string *s;
1344 int i, x;
1346 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1347 of S to the right of that box line. */
1348 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1349 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1350 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
1351 else
1352 x = s->x;
1354 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->gidx is the index of
1355 the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1356 S->gidx == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1357 this composition. */
1359 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1360 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1361 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1363 if (s->gidx == 0)
1364 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1365 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1367 else
1369 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, ++s->gidx)
1371 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1372 x + s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2],
1373 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2 + 1],
1374 s->char2b + i, 1);
1375 if (s->face->overstrike)
1376 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1377 x + s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2] + 1,
1378 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2 + 1],
1379 s->char2b + i, 1);
1385 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1387 static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget P_ ((Widget));
1388 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel P_ ((Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1389 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *));
1390 static void cvt_pixel_dtor P_ ((XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1391 XrmValue *, Cardinal *));
1394 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1395 cannot be determined. */
1397 static struct frame *
1398 x_frame_of_widget (widget)
1399 Widget widget;
1401 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1402 Lisp_Object tail;
1403 struct frame *f;
1405 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1407 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1408 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1409 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1410 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1411 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1412 widget = XtParent (widget);
1414 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1415 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1416 for (tail = Vframe_list; GC_CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1417 if (GC_FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1418 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1419 (f->output_data.nothing != 1
1420 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1421 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1422 return f;
1424 abort ();
1428 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on the screen and display of
1429 widget WIDGET in colormap CMAP. If an exact match cannot be
1430 allocated, try the nearest color available. Value is non-zero
1431 if successful. This is called from lwlib. */
1434 x_alloc_nearest_color_for_widget (widget, cmap, color)
1435 Widget widget;
1436 Colormap cmap;
1437 XColor *color;
1439 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1440 return x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color);
1444 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1445 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1446 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1447 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1448 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1449 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1452 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (widget, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
1453 Widget widget;
1454 Display *display;
1455 Colormap cmap;
1456 unsigned long *pixel;
1457 double factor;
1458 int delta;
1460 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1461 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1465 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1466 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1468 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1470 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1471 sizeof (Screen *)},
1472 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1473 sizeof (Colormap)}
1477 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1478 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1480 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1483 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1485 DPY is the display we are working on.
1487 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1488 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1489 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1490 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1492 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1493 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1495 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1496 we allocated the color or not.
1498 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1500 static Boolean
1501 cvt_string_to_pixel (dpy, args, nargs, from, to, closure_ret)
1502 Display *dpy;
1503 XrmValue *args;
1504 Cardinal *nargs;
1505 XrmValue *from, *to;
1506 XtPointer *closure_ret;
1508 Screen *screen;
1509 Colormap cmap;
1510 Pixel pixel;
1511 String color_name;
1512 XColor color;
1514 if (*nargs != 2)
1516 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1517 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1518 "XtToolkitError",
1519 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1520 return False;
1523 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1524 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1525 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1527 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1529 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1530 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1532 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1534 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1535 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1537 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1538 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1540 pixel = color.pixel;
1541 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1543 else
1545 String params[1];
1546 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1548 params[0] = color_name;
1549 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1550 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1551 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1552 params, &nparams);
1553 return False;
1556 if (to->addr != NULL)
1558 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1560 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1561 return False;
1564 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1566 else
1568 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1569 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1572 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1573 return True;
1577 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1578 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1579 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1581 APP is the application context in which we work.
1583 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1584 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1585 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1587 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1589 static void
1590 cvt_pixel_dtor (app, to, closure, args, nargs)
1591 XtAppContext app;
1592 XrmValuePtr to;
1593 XtPointer closure;
1594 XrmValuePtr args;
1595 Cardinal *nargs;
1597 if (*nargs != 2)
1599 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1600 "XtToolkitError",
1601 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1602 NULL, NULL);
1604 else if (closure != NULL)
1606 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1607 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1608 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1609 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1610 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1615 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1618 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1619 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1620 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1621 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1623 static const XColor *
1624 x_color_cells (dpy, ncells)
1625 Display *dpy;
1626 int *ncells;
1628 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1630 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1632 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1633 int i;
1635 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1636 = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1637 dpyinfo->color_cells
1638 = (XColor *) xmalloc (dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1639 * sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1641 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells; ++i)
1642 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1644 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1645 dpyinfo->color_cells, dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1648 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1649 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1653 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1654 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1656 void
1657 x_query_colors (f, colors, ncolors)
1658 struct frame *f;
1659 XColor *colors;
1660 int ncolors;
1662 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1664 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1666 int i;
1667 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1669 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1670 xassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1671 xassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1672 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1675 else
1676 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1680 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1681 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1683 void
1684 x_query_color (f, color)
1685 struct frame *f;
1686 XColor *color;
1688 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1692 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1693 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1694 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1695 allocated. */
1697 static int
1698 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, color)
1699 Display *dpy;
1700 Colormap cmap;
1701 XColor *color;
1703 int rc;
1705 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1706 if (rc == 0)
1708 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1709 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1710 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1711 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1712 int nearest, i;
1713 unsigned long nearest_delta = ~0;
1714 int ncells;
1715 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1717 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1719 long dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1720 long dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1721 long dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1722 unsigned long delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1724 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1726 nearest = i;
1727 nearest_delta = delta;
1731 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1732 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1733 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1734 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1736 else
1738 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1739 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1740 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1741 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1742 XColor *cached_color;
1744 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1745 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1746 (cached_color->red != color->red
1747 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1748 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1750 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1751 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1752 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1756 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1757 if (rc)
1758 register_color (color->pixel);
1759 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1761 return rc;
1765 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1766 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1767 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1768 allocated. */
1771 x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color)
1772 struct frame *f;
1773 Colormap cmap;
1774 XColor *color;
1776 gamma_correct (f, color);
1777 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1781 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1782 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1783 get color reference counts right. */
1785 unsigned long
1786 x_copy_color (f, pixel)
1787 struct frame *f;
1788 unsigned long pixel;
1790 XColor color;
1792 color.pixel = pixel;
1793 BLOCK_INPUT;
1794 x_query_color (f, &color);
1795 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1796 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1797 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1798 register_color (pixel);
1799 #endif
1800 return color.pixel;
1804 /* Allocate color PIXEL on display DPY. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1805 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1806 get color reference counts right. */
1808 unsigned long
1809 x_copy_dpy_color (dpy, cmap, pixel)
1810 Display *dpy;
1811 Colormap cmap;
1812 unsigned long pixel;
1814 XColor color;
1816 color.pixel = pixel;
1817 BLOCK_INPUT;
1818 XQueryColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1819 XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1820 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1821 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1822 register_color (pixel);
1823 #endif
1824 return color.pixel;
1828 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1829 boosted.
1831 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1832 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1833 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1834 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1835 use an additional additive factor.
1837 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1838 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1839 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1842 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1843 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1844 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1845 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1846 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1847 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1849 static int
1850 x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
1851 struct frame *f;
1852 Display *display;
1853 Colormap cmap;
1854 unsigned long *pixel;
1855 double factor;
1856 int delta;
1858 XColor color, new;
1859 long bright;
1860 int success_p;
1862 /* Get RGB color values. */
1863 color.pixel = *pixel;
1864 x_query_color (f, &color);
1866 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1867 xassert (factor >= 0);
1868 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1869 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1870 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1872 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1873 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1875 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1876 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1877 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1878 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1879 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1881 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1882 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1883 /* The additive adjustment. */
1884 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1886 if (factor < 1)
1888 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1889 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1890 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1892 else
1894 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1895 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1896 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1900 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1901 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1902 if (success_p)
1904 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1906 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1907 delta to the RGB values. */
1908 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1910 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1911 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1912 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1913 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1915 else
1916 success_p = 1;
1917 *pixel = new.pixel;
1920 return success_p;
1924 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1925 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1926 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1927 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1928 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1929 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1931 static void
1932 x_setup_relief_color (f, relief, factor, delta, default_pixel)
1933 struct frame *f;
1934 struct relief *relief;
1935 double factor;
1936 int delta;
1937 unsigned long default_pixel;
1939 XGCValues xgcv;
1940 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1941 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1942 unsigned long pixel;
1943 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1944 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1945 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1946 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1948 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1949 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1951 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1952 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1953 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1954 if (relief->gc
1955 && relief->allocated_p)
1957 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1958 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1961 /* Allocate new color. */
1962 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1963 pixel = background;
1964 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1965 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1967 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1968 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1971 if (relief->gc == 0)
1973 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1974 mask |= GCStipple;
1975 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1977 else
1978 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1982 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1984 static void
1985 x_setup_relief_colors (s)
1986 struct glyph_string *s;
1988 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1989 unsigned long color;
1991 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1992 color = s->face->box_color;
1993 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1994 && s->img->pixmap
1995 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1996 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1997 else
1999 XGCValues xgcv;
2001 /* Get the background color of the face. */
2002 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
2003 color = xgcv.background;
2006 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
2007 || color != di->relief_background)
2009 di->relief_background = color;
2010 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
2011 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
2012 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
2013 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
2018 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
2019 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
2020 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
2021 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
2022 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
2023 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
2024 when drawing. */
2026 static void
2027 x_draw_relief_rect (f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2028 raised_p, top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
2029 struct frame *f;
2030 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width;
2031 int top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, raised_p;
2032 XRectangle *clip_rect;
2034 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
2035 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
2036 int i;
2037 GC gc;
2039 if (raised_p)
2040 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2041 else
2042 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2043 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2045 /* Top. */
2046 if (top_p)
2047 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2048 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2049 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2050 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2052 /* Left. */
2053 if (left_p)
2054 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2055 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2056 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
2058 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2059 if (raised_p)
2060 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2061 else
2062 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2063 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2065 /* Bottom. */
2066 if (bot_p)
2067 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2068 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2069 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2070 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2072 /* Right. */
2073 if (right_p)
2074 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2075 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2076 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
2078 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2082 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2083 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2084 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2085 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2086 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2087 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2089 static void
2090 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2091 left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
2092 struct glyph_string *s;
2093 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width, left_p, right_p;
2094 XRectangle *clip_rect;
2096 XGCValues xgcv;
2098 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2099 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2100 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2102 /* Top. */
2103 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2104 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2106 /* Left. */
2107 if (left_p)
2108 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2109 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2111 /* Bottom. */
2112 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2113 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2115 /* Right. */
2116 if (right_p)
2117 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2118 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2120 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2121 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2125 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2127 static void
2128 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s)
2129 struct glyph_string *s;
2131 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2132 int left_p, right_p;
2133 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2134 XRectangle clip_rect;
2136 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2137 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2138 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2140 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2141 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2142 ? s->first_glyph
2143 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2145 width = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2146 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2147 left_x = s->x;
2148 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2149 ? last_x - 1
2150 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2151 top_y = s->y;
2152 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2154 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2155 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2156 && (s->prev == NULL
2157 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2158 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2159 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2160 && (s->next == NULL
2161 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2163 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2165 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2166 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2167 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2168 else
2170 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2171 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2172 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2177 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2179 static void
2180 x_draw_image_foreground (s)
2181 struct glyph_string *s;
2183 int x = s->x;
2184 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2186 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2187 right of that line. */
2188 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2189 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2190 && s->slice.x == 0)
2191 x += abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2193 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2194 by that margin. */
2195 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2196 x += s->img->hmargin;
2197 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2198 y += s->img->vmargin;
2200 if (s->img->pixmap)
2202 if (s->img->mask)
2204 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2205 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2206 trust on the shape extension to be available
2207 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2208 manually. */
2209 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2210 | GCFunction);
2211 XGCValues xgcv;
2212 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2214 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2215 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2216 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2217 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2218 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2220 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2221 image_rect.x = x;
2222 image_rect.y = y;
2223 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2224 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2225 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2226 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2227 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2228 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2230 else
2232 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2234 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2235 image_rect.x = x;
2236 image_rect.y = y;
2237 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2238 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2239 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2240 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2241 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2242 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2244 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2245 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2246 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2247 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2248 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2249 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2250 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2252 int r = s->img->relief;
2253 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2254 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2255 x - r, y - r,
2256 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2257 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2261 else
2262 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2263 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2264 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2268 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2270 static void
2271 x_draw_image_relief (s)
2272 struct glyph_string *s;
2274 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p;
2275 XRectangle r;
2276 int x = s->x;
2277 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2279 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2280 right of that line. */
2281 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2282 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2283 && s->slice.x == 0)
2284 x += abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2286 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2287 by that margin. */
2288 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2289 x += s->img->hmargin;
2290 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2291 y += s->img->vmargin;
2293 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2294 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2296 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2297 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2299 else
2301 thick = abs (s->img->relief);
2302 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2305 x0 = x - thick;
2306 y0 = y - thick;
2307 x1 = x + s->slice.width + thick - 1;
2308 y1 = y + s->slice.height + thick - 1;
2310 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2311 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2312 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2313 s->slice.y == 0,
2314 s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height,
2315 s->slice.x == 0,
2316 s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width,
2317 &r);
2321 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2323 static void
2324 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap)
2325 struct glyph_string *s;
2326 Pixmap pixmap;
2328 int x = 0;
2329 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2331 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2332 right of that line. */
2333 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2334 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2335 && s->slice.x == 0)
2336 x += abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2338 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2339 by that margin. */
2340 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2341 x += s->img->hmargin;
2342 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2343 y += s->img->vmargin;
2345 if (s->img->pixmap)
2347 if (s->img->mask)
2349 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2350 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2351 trust on the shape extension to be available
2352 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2353 manually. */
2354 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2355 | GCFunction);
2356 XGCValues xgcv;
2358 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2359 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2360 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2361 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2362 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2364 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2365 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2366 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2367 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2369 else
2371 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2372 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2373 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2375 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2376 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2377 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2378 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2379 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2380 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2381 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2383 int r = s->img->relief;
2384 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2385 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2386 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2387 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2391 else
2392 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2393 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2394 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2398 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2399 give the rectangle to draw. */
2401 static void
2402 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
2403 struct glyph_string *s;
2404 int x, y, w, h;
2406 if (s->stippled_p)
2408 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2409 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2410 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2411 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2413 else
2414 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2418 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2420 s->y
2421 s->x +-------------------------
2422 | s->face->box
2424 | +-------------------------
2425 | | s->img->margin
2427 | | +-------------------
2428 | | | the image
2432 static void
2433 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s)
2434 struct glyph_string *s;
2436 int box_line_hwidth = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2437 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2438 int height;
2439 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2441 height = s->height;
2442 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2443 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2444 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2445 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2447 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2448 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2449 flickering. */
2450 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2451 if (height > s->slice.height
2452 || s->img->hmargin
2453 || s->img->vmargin
2454 || s->img->mask
2455 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2456 || s->width != s->background_width)
2458 if (s->img->mask)
2460 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2461 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2462 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2463 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2464 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2466 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2467 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2468 s->background_width,
2469 s->height, depth);
2471 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2472 pixmap. */
2473 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2475 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2476 if (s->stippled_p)
2478 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2479 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2480 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2481 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2482 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2484 else
2486 XGCValues xgcv;
2487 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2488 &xgcv);
2489 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2490 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2491 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2492 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2495 else
2497 int x = s->x;
2498 int y = s->y;
2500 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2501 && s->slice.x == 0)
2502 x += box_line_hwidth;
2504 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2505 y += box_line_vwidth;
2507 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2510 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2513 /* Draw the foreground. */
2514 if (pixmap != None)
2516 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2517 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2518 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2519 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2520 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2522 else
2523 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2525 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2526 if (s->img->relief
2527 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2528 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2529 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2533 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2535 static void
2536 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s)
2537 struct glyph_string *s;
2539 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2540 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2542 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2543 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2545 /* If `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor
2546 as wide as the stretch glyph. */
2547 int width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), s->background_width);
2549 /* Draw cursor. */
2550 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, s->x, s->y, width, s->height);
2552 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2553 if (width < s->background_width)
2555 int x = s->x + width, y = s->y;
2556 int w = s->background_width - width, h = s->height;
2557 XRectangle r;
2558 GC gc;
2560 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2561 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2563 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2564 gc = s->gc;
2566 else
2567 gc = s->face->gc;
2569 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2570 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2572 if (s->face->stipple)
2574 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2575 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2576 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2577 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2579 else
2581 XGCValues xgcv;
2582 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2583 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2584 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2585 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2589 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2590 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, s->x, s->y, s->background_width,
2591 s->height);
2593 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2597 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2599 static void
2600 x_draw_glyph_string (s)
2601 struct glyph_string *s;
2603 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2605 /* If S draws into the background of its successor, draw the
2606 background of the successor first so that S can draw into it.
2607 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2608 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2610 xassert (s->next->img == NULL);
2611 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s->next);
2612 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s->next);
2613 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s->next, 1);
2616 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2617 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2619 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2620 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2621 if (!s->for_overlaps
2622 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2623 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2624 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2627 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2628 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2629 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2630 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2631 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2633 else
2634 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2636 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2638 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2639 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2640 break;
2642 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2643 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2644 break;
2646 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2647 if (s->for_overlaps)
2648 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2649 else
2650 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2651 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2652 break;
2654 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2655 if (s->for_overlaps || s->gidx > 0)
2656 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2657 else
2658 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2659 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2660 break;
2662 default:
2663 abort ();
2666 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2668 /* Draw underline. */
2669 if (s->face->underline_p)
2671 unsigned long tem, h;
2672 int y;
2674 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2675 if (!XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_THICKNESS, &h))
2676 h = 1;
2678 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2679 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2680 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2681 specs, and its default is
2683 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2684 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2686 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2687 && XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_POSITION, &tem))
2688 y = s->ybase + (long) tem;
2689 else if (s->face->font)
2690 y = s->ybase + (s->face->font->max_bounds.descent + 1) / 2;
2691 else
2692 y = s->y + s->height - h;
2694 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2695 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2696 s->x, y, s->width, h);
2697 else
2699 XGCValues xgcv;
2700 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2701 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2702 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2703 s->x, y, s->width, h);
2704 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2708 /* Draw overline. */
2709 if (s->face->overline_p)
2711 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2713 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2714 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2715 s->width, h);
2716 else
2718 XGCValues xgcv;
2719 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2720 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2721 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2722 s->width, h);
2723 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2727 /* Draw strike-through. */
2728 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2730 unsigned long h = 1;
2731 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2733 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2734 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2735 s->width, h);
2736 else
2738 XGCValues xgcv;
2739 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2740 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2741 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2742 s->width, h);
2743 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2747 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2748 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2749 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2752 /* Reset clipping. */
2753 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2756 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2758 void
2759 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (f, x, y, width, height, shift_by)
2760 struct frame *f;
2761 int x, y, width, height, shift_by;
2763 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2764 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2765 x, y, width, height,
2766 x + shift_by, y);
2769 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2770 for X frames. */
2772 static void
2773 x_delete_glyphs (n)
2774 register int n;
2776 abort ();
2780 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2781 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2783 void
2784 x_clear_area (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures)
2785 Display *dpy;
2786 Window window;
2787 int x, y;
2788 int width, height;
2789 int exposures;
2791 xassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2792 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
2796 /* Clear entire frame. If updating_frame is non-null, clear that
2797 frame. Otherwise clear the selected frame. */
2799 static void
2800 x_clear_frame ()
2802 struct frame *f;
2804 if (updating_frame)
2805 f = updating_frame;
2806 else
2807 f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
2809 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2810 longer visible. */
2811 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
2812 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
2813 output_cursor.x = -1;
2815 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
2816 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
2817 BLOCK_INPUT;
2818 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
2820 /* We have to clear the scroll bars, too. If we have changed
2821 colors or something like that, then they should be notified. */
2822 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
2824 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
2826 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2831 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
2833 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
2834 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
2836 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
2839 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
2840 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
2842 static int
2843 timeval_subtract (result, x, y)
2844 struct timeval *result, x, y;
2846 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
2847 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
2848 if (x.tv_usec < y.tv_usec)
2850 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000 + 1;
2851 y.tv_usec -= 1000000 * nsec;
2852 y.tv_sec += nsec;
2855 if (x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec > 1000000)
2857 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000;
2858 y.tv_usec += 1000000 * nsec;
2859 y.tv_sec -= nsec;
2862 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
2863 positive. */
2864 result->tv_sec = x.tv_sec - y.tv_sec;
2865 result->tv_usec = x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec;
2867 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
2868 negative. */
2869 return x.tv_sec < y.tv_sec;
2872 void
2873 XTflash (f)
2874 struct frame *f;
2876 BLOCK_INPUT;
2879 GC gc;
2881 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
2882 pixels into background pixels. */
2884 XGCValues values;
2886 values.function = GXxor;
2887 values.foreground = (f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel
2888 ^ f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
2890 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2891 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
2895 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
2896 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
2897 /* Height of each line to flash. */
2898 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
2899 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
2900 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2901 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2903 int width;
2905 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
2906 edge it is next to. */
2907 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
2909 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
2910 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
2911 break;
2913 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
2914 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
2915 break;
2917 default:
2918 break;
2921 width = flash_right - flash_left;
2923 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
2924 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
2926 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2927 flash_left,
2928 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
2929 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
2930 width, flash_height);
2931 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2932 flash_left,
2933 (height - flash_height
2934 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
2935 width, flash_height);
2937 else
2938 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
2939 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2940 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
2941 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
2943 x_flush (f);
2946 struct timeval wakeup;
2948 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
2950 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
2951 wakeup.tv_usec += 150000;
2952 wakeup.tv_sec += (wakeup.tv_usec / 1000000);
2953 wakeup.tv_usec %= 1000000;
2955 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
2956 available. */
2957 while (! detect_input_pending ())
2959 struct timeval current;
2960 struct timeval timeout;
2962 EMACS_GET_TIME (current);
2964 /* Break if result would be negative. */
2965 if (timeval_subtract (&current, wakeup, current))
2966 break;
2968 /* How long `select' should wait. */
2969 timeout.tv_sec = 0;
2970 timeout.tv_usec = 10000;
2972 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
2973 select (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout);
2977 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
2978 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
2980 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2981 flash_left,
2982 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
2983 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
2984 width, flash_height);
2985 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2986 flash_left,
2987 (height - flash_height
2988 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
2989 width, flash_height);
2991 else
2992 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
2993 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2994 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
2995 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
2997 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
2998 x_flush (f);
3002 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3005 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
3008 /* Make audible bell. */
3010 void
3011 XTring_bell ()
3013 struct frame *f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3015 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3017 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
3018 if (visible_bell)
3019 XTflash (f);
3020 else
3021 #endif
3023 BLOCK_INPUT;
3024 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3025 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3026 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3032 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3033 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3034 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3035 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3037 static void
3038 XTset_terminal_window (n)
3039 register int n;
3041 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3046 /***********************************************************************
3047 Line Dance
3048 ***********************************************************************/
3050 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3051 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3053 static void
3054 x_ins_del_lines (vpos, n)
3055 int vpos, n;
3057 abort ();
3061 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3063 static void
3064 x_scroll_run (w, run)
3065 struct window *w;
3066 struct run *run;
3068 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3069 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3071 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3072 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3073 fringe of W. */
3074 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3076 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3077 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3078 bottom_y = y + height;
3080 if (to_y < from_y)
3082 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3083 line at the bottom. */
3084 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3085 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3086 else
3087 height = run->height;
3089 else
3091 /* Scolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3092 at the bottom. */
3093 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3094 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3095 else
3096 height = run->height;
3099 BLOCK_INPUT;
3101 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3102 updated_window = w;
3103 x_clear_cursor (w);
3105 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3106 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3107 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3108 x, from_y,
3109 width, height,
3110 x, to_y);
3112 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3117 /***********************************************************************
3118 Exposure Events
3119 ***********************************************************************/
3122 static void
3123 frame_highlight (f)
3124 struct frame *f;
3126 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3127 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3128 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3129 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3130 BLOCK_INPUT;
3131 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3132 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3133 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3134 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3137 static void
3138 frame_unhighlight (f)
3139 struct frame *f;
3141 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3142 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3143 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3144 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3145 BLOCK_INPUT;
3146 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3147 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3148 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3149 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3152 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3153 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3154 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3155 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3156 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3158 static void
3159 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame)
3160 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3161 struct frame *frame;
3163 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3165 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3167 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3168 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3169 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3171 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3172 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3174 #if 0
3175 selected_frame = frame;
3176 XSETFRAME (XWINDOW (selected_frame->selected_window)->frame,
3177 selected_frame);
3178 Fselect_window (selected_frame->selected_window, Qnil);
3179 choose_minibuf_frame ();
3180 #endif /* ! 0 */
3182 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3183 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3184 else
3185 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3188 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3191 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3192 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3193 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3195 static void
3196 x_focus_changed (type, state, dpyinfo, frame, bufp)
3197 int type;
3198 int state;
3199 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3200 struct frame *frame;
3201 struct input_event *bufp;
3203 if (type == FocusIn)
3205 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3207 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3208 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3210 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3211 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3212 if (GC_NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3213 && GC_CONSP (Vframe_list)
3214 && !GC_NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3216 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3217 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3221 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3223 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3224 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3225 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3226 #endif
3228 else if (type == FocusOut)
3230 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3232 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3234 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3235 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3238 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3239 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3240 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3241 #endif
3245 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3246 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3248 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3250 static void
3251 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, event, bufp)
3252 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3253 XEvent *event;
3254 struct input_event *bufp;
3256 struct frame *frame;
3258 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3259 if (! frame)
3260 return;
3262 switch (event->type)
3264 case EnterNotify:
3265 case LeaveNotify:
3267 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3268 int focus_state
3269 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3271 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3272 && event->xcrossing.focus
3273 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3274 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3275 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3276 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3278 break;
3280 case FocusIn:
3281 case FocusOut:
3282 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3283 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3284 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3285 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3286 break;
3291 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3293 void
3294 x_mouse_leave (dpyinfo)
3295 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3297 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3300 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3301 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3302 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3304 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3305 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3306 the appropriate X display info. */
3308 static void
3309 XTframe_rehighlight (frame)
3310 struct frame *frame;
3312 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3315 static void
3316 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo)
3317 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3319 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3321 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3323 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3324 = ((GC_FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3325 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3326 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3327 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3329 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
3330 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3333 else
3334 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3336 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3338 if (old_highlight)
3339 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3340 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3341 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3347 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3349 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3350 static void
3351 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo)
3352 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3354 int min_code, max_code;
3355 KeySym *syms;
3356 int syms_per_code;
3357 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3359 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3360 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3361 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3362 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3363 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3365 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
3366 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3367 #else
3368 min_code = dpyinfo->display->min_keycode;
3369 max_code = dpyinfo->display->max_keycode;
3370 #endif
3372 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3373 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3374 &syms_per_code);
3375 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3377 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3378 Alt keysyms are on. */
3380 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3381 int found_alt_or_meta;
3383 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3385 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3386 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3388 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3390 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3391 if (code == 0)
3392 continue;
3394 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3396 int code_col;
3398 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3400 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3402 switch (sym)
3404 case XK_Meta_L:
3405 case XK_Meta_R:
3406 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3407 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3408 break;
3410 case XK_Alt_L:
3411 case XK_Alt_R:
3412 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3413 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3414 break;
3416 case XK_Hyper_L:
3417 case XK_Hyper_R:
3418 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3419 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3420 code_col = syms_per_code;
3421 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3422 break;
3424 case XK_Super_L:
3425 case XK_Super_R:
3426 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3427 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3428 code_col = syms_per_code;
3429 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3430 break;
3432 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3433 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3434 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3435 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3436 code_col = syms_per_code;
3437 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3438 break;
3446 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3447 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3449 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3450 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3453 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3454 make them just meta, not alt. */
3455 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3457 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3460 XFree ((char *) syms);
3461 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3464 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3465 Emacs uses. */
3467 static unsigned int
3468 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3469 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3470 unsigned int state;
3472 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3473 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3474 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3475 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3476 Lisp_Object tem;
3478 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3479 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3480 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3481 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3482 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3483 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3484 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3485 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3488 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3489 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3490 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3491 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3492 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3493 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3496 static unsigned int
3497 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3498 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3499 unsigned int state;
3501 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3502 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3503 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3504 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3506 Lisp_Object tem;
3508 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3509 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3510 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3511 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3512 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3513 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3514 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3515 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3518 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3519 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3520 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3521 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3522 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3523 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3526 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3528 char *
3529 x_get_keysym_name (keysym)
3530 KeySym keysym;
3532 char *value;
3534 BLOCK_INPUT;
3535 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3536 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3538 return value;
3543 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3545 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3547 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3548 the mouse. */
3550 static Lisp_Object
3551 construct_mouse_click (result, event, f)
3552 struct input_event *result;
3553 XButtonEvent *event;
3554 struct frame *f;
3556 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3557 otherwise. */
3558 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3559 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3560 result->timestamp = event->time;
3561 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3562 event->state)
3563 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3564 ? up_modifier
3565 : down_modifier));
3567 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3568 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3569 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3570 result->arg = Qnil;
3571 return Qnil;
3575 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3576 The input handler calls this.
3578 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3579 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3580 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3581 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3583 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3584 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3586 static int
3587 note_mouse_movement (frame, event)
3588 FRAME_PTR frame;
3589 XMotionEvent *event;
3591 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3592 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3593 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3595 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3597 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3598 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3599 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3600 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
3601 return 1;
3605 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3606 if (frame != last_mouse_glyph_frame
3607 || event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3608 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3609 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3610 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3612 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3613 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3614 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3615 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3616 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3617 last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3618 return 1;
3621 return 0;
3625 /************************************************************************
3626 Mouse Face
3627 ************************************************************************/
3629 static void
3630 redo_mouse_highlight ()
3632 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3633 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3634 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3635 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3636 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3641 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3642 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3644 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3645 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3646 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3647 position on the scroll bar.
3649 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3650 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3651 the mouse is over.
3653 Set *TIME to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3654 was at this position.
3656 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3658 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3659 movement. */
3661 static void
3662 XTmouse_position (fp, insist, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
3663 FRAME_PTR *fp;
3664 int insist;
3665 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
3666 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
3667 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
3668 unsigned long *time;
3670 FRAME_PTR f1;
3672 BLOCK_INPUT;
3674 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3675 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time);
3676 else
3678 Window root;
3679 int root_x, root_y;
3681 Window dummy_window;
3682 int dummy;
3684 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3686 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3687 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3688 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3689 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3691 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3693 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3694 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3695 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3697 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3698 &root,
3700 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3701 a different screen. */
3702 &dummy_window,
3704 /* The position on that root window. */
3705 &root_x, &root_y,
3707 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3708 &dummy, &dummy,
3710 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3711 we don't care. */
3712 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3714 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3715 containing the pointer. */
3717 Window win, child;
3718 int win_x, win_y;
3719 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3720 int count;
3722 win = root;
3724 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3725 structure is changing at the same time this function
3726 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3728 count = x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3730 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3731 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3733 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3734 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3735 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3737 /* From-window, to-window. */
3738 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3740 /* From-position, to-position. */
3741 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3743 /* Child of win. */
3744 &child);
3745 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3747 else
3749 while (1)
3751 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3753 /* From-window, to-window. */
3754 root, win,
3756 /* From-position, to-position. */
3757 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3759 /* Child of win. */
3760 &child);
3762 if (child == None || child == win)
3763 break;
3765 win = child;
3766 parent_x = win_x;
3767 parent_y = win_y;
3770 /* Now we know that:
3771 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3772 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3773 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3774 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3775 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3776 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3777 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3778 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3779 never use them in that case.) */
3781 /* Is win one of our frames? */
3782 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3784 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3785 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
3786 on the frame. */
3787 if (f1 != NULL
3788 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
3789 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
3790 f1 = NULL;
3791 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3794 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
3795 f1 = 0;
3797 x_uncatch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), count);
3799 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
3800 if (! f1)
3802 struct scroll_bar *bar;
3804 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
3806 if (bar)
3808 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
3809 win_x = parent_x;
3810 win_y = parent_y;
3814 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
3815 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3817 if (f1)
3819 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
3820 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
3821 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
3822 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
3823 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
3824 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
3825 the frame are divided into. */
3827 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3828 last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
3830 *bar_window = Qnil;
3831 *part = 0;
3832 *fp = f1;
3833 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
3834 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
3835 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
3840 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3845 /***********************************************************************
3846 Scroll bars
3847 ***********************************************************************/
3849 /* Scroll bar support. */
3851 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
3852 manages it.
3853 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
3854 bits. */
3856 static struct scroll_bar *
3857 x_window_to_scroll_bar (display, window_id)
3858 Display *display;
3859 Window window_id;
3861 Lisp_Object tail;
3863 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
3864 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
3865 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
3867 for (tail = Vframe_list;
3868 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
3869 tail = XCDR (tail))
3871 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
3873 frame = XCAR (tail);
3874 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
3875 if (! GC_FRAMEP (frame))
3876 abort ();
3878 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
3879 right window ID. */
3880 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
3881 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
3882 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
3883 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
3884 ! GC_NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
3885 condemned = Qnil,
3886 ! GC_NILP (bar));
3887 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
3888 if (SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)) == window_id &&
3889 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
3890 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
3893 return 0;
3897 #if defined USE_LUCID
3899 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
3900 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
3902 static Widget
3903 x_window_to_menu_bar (window)
3904 Window window;
3906 Lisp_Object tail;
3908 for (tail = Vframe_list;
3909 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
3910 tail = XCDR (tail))
3912 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
3913 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
3915 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
3916 return menu_bar;
3919 return NULL;
3922 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
3925 /************************************************************************
3926 Toolkit scroll bars
3927 ************************************************************************/
3929 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3931 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event P_ ((XEvent *, struct input_event *));
3932 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event P_ ((Lisp_Object, int, int, int));
3933 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar P_ ((struct frame *,
3934 struct scroll_bar *));
3935 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb P_ ((struct scroll_bar *,
3936 int, int, int));
3939 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
3940 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
3942 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
3944 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
3946 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
3948 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
3949 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
3951 #ifndef USE_GTK
3952 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
3954 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
3956 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
3958 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
3959 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
3960 to avoid jerkyness. */
3962 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
3964 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
3965 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
3966 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
3967 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
3969 static void
3970 xt_action_hook (widget, client_data, action_name, event, params,
3971 num_params)
3972 Widget widget;
3973 XtPointer client_data;
3974 String action_name;
3975 XEvent *event;
3976 String *params;
3977 Cardinal *num_params;
3979 int scroll_bar_p;
3980 char *end_action;
3982 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
3983 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
3984 end_action = "Release";
3985 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
3986 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
3987 end_action = "EndScroll";
3988 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
3990 if (scroll_bar_p
3991 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
3992 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
3994 struct window *w;
3996 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
3997 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
3998 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4000 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4002 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4003 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4004 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4006 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4007 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4009 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4010 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4013 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4015 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4016 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4018 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4019 static int scroll_bar_windows_size;
4022 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4023 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4024 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4025 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4027 static void
4028 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window, part, portion, whole)
4029 Lisp_Object window;
4030 int part, portion, whole;
4032 XEvent event;
4033 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4034 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4035 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4036 int i;
4038 BLOCK_INPUT;
4040 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4041 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4042 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4043 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4044 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4045 ev->format = 32;
4047 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4048 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4049 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4050 into that array in the event. */
4051 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4052 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4053 break;
4055 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4057 int new_size = max (10, 2 * scroll_bar_windows_size);
4058 size_t nbytes = new_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4059 size_t old_nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4061 scroll_bar_windows = (struct window **) xrealloc (scroll_bar_windows,
4062 nbytes);
4063 bzero (&scroll_bar_windows[i], nbytes - old_nbytes);
4064 scroll_bar_windows_size = new_size;
4067 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4068 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4069 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4070 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4071 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4072 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4074 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4075 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4077 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4078 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4079 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4080 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4081 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4085 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4086 in *IEVENT. */
4088 static void
4089 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (event, ievent)
4090 XEvent *event;
4091 struct input_event *ievent;
4093 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4094 Lisp_Object window;
4095 struct frame *f;
4096 struct window *w;
4098 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4099 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4101 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4102 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4104 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4105 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4106 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4107 #ifdef USE_GTK
4108 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4109 #else
4110 ievent->timestamp = XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
4111 #endif
4112 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4113 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4114 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4115 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4116 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4120 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4122 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4124 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4127 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4128 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4129 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4131 static void
4132 xm_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4133 Widget widget;
4134 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4136 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4137 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4138 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4140 switch (cs->reason)
4142 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4143 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4144 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4145 break;
4147 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4148 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4149 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4150 break;
4152 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4153 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4154 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4155 break;
4157 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4158 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4159 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4160 break;
4162 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4163 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4164 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4165 break;
4167 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4168 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4169 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4170 break;
4172 case XmCR_DRAG:
4174 int slider_size;
4176 /* Get the slider size. */
4177 BLOCK_INPUT;
4178 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4179 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4181 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4182 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4183 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4184 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4186 break;
4188 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4189 break;
4192 if (part >= 0)
4194 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4195 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4196 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4201 #else /* !USE_MOTIF, i.e. Xaw or GTK */
4202 #ifdef USE_GTK
4203 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4204 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4206 static void
4207 xg_scroll_callback (widget, data)
4208 GtkRange *widget;
4209 gpointer data;
4211 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) data;
4212 gdouble previous;
4213 gdouble position;
4214 gdouble *p;
4215 int diff;
4217 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4218 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (widget));
4220 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4222 p = g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA);
4223 if (! p)
4225 p = (gdouble*) xmalloc (sizeof (gdouble));
4226 *p = XG_SB_MIN;
4227 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA, p);
4230 previous = *p;
4231 *p = position;
4233 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return;
4235 diff = (int) (position - previous);
4237 if (diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4239 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4240 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4242 else if (-diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4244 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4245 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4247 else if (diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4249 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4250 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4252 else if (-diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4254 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4255 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4257 else
4259 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4260 whole = adj->upper - adj->page_size;
4261 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4262 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4265 if (part >= 0)
4267 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4268 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4269 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4273 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4275 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4276 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4277 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4278 the thumb is. */
4280 static void
4281 xaw_jump_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4282 Widget widget;
4283 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4285 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4286 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4287 float shown;
4288 int whole, portion, height;
4289 int part;
4291 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4292 BLOCK_INPUT;
4293 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4294 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4296 whole = 10000000;
4297 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4299 if (shown < 1 && (abs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0/height))
4300 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4301 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4302 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4303 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4304 bottom). */
4305 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4306 else
4307 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4309 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4310 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4311 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4312 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4316 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4317 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4318 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4319 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4320 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4321 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4322 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4324 static void
4325 xaw_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4326 Widget widget;
4327 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4329 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4330 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4331 int position = (long) call_data;
4332 Dimension height;
4333 int part;
4335 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4336 BLOCK_INPUT;
4337 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4338 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4340 if (abs (position) >= height)
4341 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4343 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4344 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4345 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && abs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4346 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4347 else
4348 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4350 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4351 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4352 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4353 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4356 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4357 #endif /* not USE_MOTIF */
4359 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4361 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4362 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4364 #ifdef USE_GTK
4365 static void
4366 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4367 struct frame *f;
4368 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4370 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4372 BLOCK_INPUT;
4373 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4374 scroll_bar_name);
4375 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4378 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4380 static void
4381 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4382 struct frame *f;
4383 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4385 Window xwindow;
4386 Widget widget;
4387 Arg av[20];
4388 int ac = 0;
4389 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4390 unsigned long pixel;
4392 BLOCK_INPUT;
4394 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4395 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4396 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4397 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4398 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4399 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4400 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4401 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4402 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4404 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4405 if (pixel != -1)
4407 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4408 ++ac;
4411 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4412 if (pixel != -1)
4414 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4415 ++ac;
4418 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4419 scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4421 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4422 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4423 (XtPointer) bar);
4424 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4425 (XtPointer) bar);
4426 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4427 (XtPointer) bar);
4428 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4429 (XtPointer) bar);
4430 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4431 (XtPointer) bar);
4432 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4433 (XtPointer) bar);
4434 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4435 (XtPointer) bar);
4437 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4438 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4440 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4441 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4442 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4443 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4445 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4447 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4448 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4449 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4450 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4451 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4452 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4453 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4454 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4456 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4457 if (pixel != -1)
4459 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4460 ++ac;
4463 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4464 if (pixel != -1)
4466 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4467 ++ac;
4470 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4472 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4473 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4475 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4476 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4477 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4478 pixel = -1;
4479 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4481 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4483 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4484 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4485 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4486 pixel = -1;
4487 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4490 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4491 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4492 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4493 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4494 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4495 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4497 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, True);
4498 ++ac;
4500 else
4501 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4502 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4503 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4505 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4506 the shadows. */
4507 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4508 ++ac;
4510 /* Specify the colors. */
4511 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4512 if (pixel != -1)
4514 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4515 ++ac;
4517 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4518 if (pixel != -1)
4520 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4521 ++ac;
4524 #endif
4526 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4527 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4530 char *initial = "";
4531 char *val = initial;
4532 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4533 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4534 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4535 #endif
4536 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4537 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4538 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4539 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4540 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4541 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4545 /* Define callbacks. */
4546 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4547 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4548 (XtPointer) bar);
4550 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4551 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4553 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4555 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4556 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4557 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4558 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4560 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4561 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4562 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4563 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, xwindow);
4565 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4567 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4570 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4571 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4573 #ifdef USE_GTK
4574 static void
4575 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4576 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4577 int portion, position, whole;
4579 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4582 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4583 static void
4584 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4585 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4586 int portion, position, whole;
4588 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4589 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4590 float top, shown;
4592 BLOCK_INPUT;
4594 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4596 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4597 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4598 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4599 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4600 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4601 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4602 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4603 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4604 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4605 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4606 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4607 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4608 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4609 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4610 whole += portion;
4612 if (whole <= 0)
4613 top = 0, shown = 1;
4614 else
4616 top = (float) position / whole;
4617 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4620 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4622 int size, value;
4624 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4625 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4626 value. */
4627 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4628 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4629 size = max (size, 1);
4631 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4632 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4633 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4635 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4637 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4639 if (whole == 0)
4640 top = 0, shown = 1;
4641 else
4643 top = (float) position / whole;
4644 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4648 float old_top, old_shown;
4649 Dimension height;
4650 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4651 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4652 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4653 XtNheight, &height,
4654 NULL);
4656 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4657 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4658 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4659 else
4660 top = old_top;
4661 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4662 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0 / height), shown));
4664 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4665 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4666 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4667 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4669 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4670 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4671 else
4673 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4674 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4675 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4677 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4681 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4683 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4685 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4687 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4691 /************************************************************************
4692 Scroll bars, general
4693 ************************************************************************/
4695 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4696 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4697 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4698 scroll bar. */
4700 static struct scroll_bar *
4701 x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, left, width, height)
4702 struct window *w;
4703 int top, left, width, height;
4705 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4706 struct scroll_bar *bar
4707 = XSCROLL_BAR (Fmake_vector (make_number (SCROLL_BAR_VEC_SIZE), Qnil));
4709 BLOCK_INPUT;
4711 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4712 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4713 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4715 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4716 unsigned long mask;
4717 Window window;
4719 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4720 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4721 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->background_pixel;
4723 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4724 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4725 | ExposureMask);
4726 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4728 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4730 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4731 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4732 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4733 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4734 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4735 left, top, width,
4736 window_box_height (w), False);
4738 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4739 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4740 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4741 top,
4742 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4743 height,
4744 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4746 CopyFromParent,
4747 CopyFromParent,
4748 CopyFromParent,
4749 /* Attributes. */
4750 mask, &a);
4751 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, window);
4753 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4755 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4756 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
4757 XSETINT (bar->left, left);
4758 XSETINT (bar->width, width);
4759 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
4760 XSETINT (bar->start, 0);
4761 XSETINT (bar->end, 0);
4762 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4764 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4765 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
4766 bar->prev = Qnil;
4767 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
4768 if (!NILP (bar->next))
4769 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
4771 /* Map the window/widget. */
4772 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4774 #ifdef USE_GTK
4775 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
4776 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
4777 top,
4778 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4779 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4780 max (height, 1));
4781 xg_show_scroll_bar (SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4782 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4783 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4784 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
4785 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4786 top,
4787 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4788 max (height, 1), 0);
4789 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
4790 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4792 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4793 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4794 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4796 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4797 return bar;
4801 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
4803 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
4804 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
4805 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
4806 events.)
4808 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
4809 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
4810 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
4811 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
4812 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
4814 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4816 static void
4817 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, rebuild)
4818 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4819 int start, end;
4820 int rebuild;
4822 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
4823 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
4824 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4825 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
4827 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
4828 if (! rebuild
4829 && start == XINT (bar->start)
4830 && end == XINT (bar->end))
4831 return;
4833 BLOCK_INPUT;
4836 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, XINT (bar->width));
4837 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
4838 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
4840 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
4841 the distance between start and end. */
4843 int length = end - start;
4845 if (start < 0)
4846 start = 0;
4847 else if (start > top_range)
4848 start = top_range;
4849 end = start + length;
4851 if (end < start)
4852 end = start;
4853 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
4854 end = top_range;
4857 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
4858 XSETINT (bar->start, start);
4859 XSETINT (bar->end, end);
4861 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
4862 if (end > top_range)
4863 end = top_range;
4865 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
4866 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
4867 that many pixels tall. */
4868 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
4870 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
4871 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4872 if (0 < start)
4873 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
4874 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4875 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4876 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
4877 inside_width, start,
4878 False);
4880 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
4881 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
4882 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
4883 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
4885 /* Draw the handle itself. */
4886 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
4887 /* x, y, width, height */
4888 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4889 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
4890 inside_width, end - start);
4892 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
4893 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
4894 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
4895 f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
4897 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
4898 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4899 if (end < inside_height)
4900 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
4901 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4902 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4903 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
4904 inside_width, inside_height - end,
4905 False);
4909 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4912 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4914 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
4915 nil. */
4917 static void
4918 x_scroll_bar_remove (bar)
4919 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4921 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4922 BLOCK_INPUT;
4924 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4925 #ifdef USE_GTK
4926 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4927 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4928 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
4929 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4930 #else
4931 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4932 #endif
4934 /* Disassociate this scroll bar from its window. */
4935 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
4937 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4941 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
4942 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
4943 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
4944 create one. */
4946 static void
4947 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (w, portion, whole, position)
4948 struct window *w;
4949 int portion, whole, position;
4951 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4952 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4953 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
4954 int window_y, window_height;
4956 /* Get window dimensions. */
4957 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
4958 top = window_y;
4959 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
4960 height = window_height;
4962 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
4963 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
4965 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
4966 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
4967 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
4968 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
4969 else
4970 sb_width = width;
4972 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
4973 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4974 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
4975 sb_left = (left +
4976 (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
4977 ? width - sb_width - (width - sb_width) / 2
4978 : 0));
4979 else
4980 sb_left = (left +
4981 (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
4982 ? (width - sb_width) / 2
4983 : width - sb_width));
4984 #else
4985 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
4986 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
4987 else
4988 sb_left = left;
4989 #endif
4991 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
4992 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
4994 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4996 BLOCK_INPUT;
4997 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4998 left, top, width, height, False);
4999 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5002 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5004 else
5006 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5007 unsigned int mask = 0;
5009 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5011 BLOCK_INPUT;
5013 if (sb_left != XINT (bar->left))
5014 mask |= CWX;
5015 if (top != XINT (bar->top))
5016 mask |= CWY;
5017 if (sb_width != XINT (bar->width))
5018 mask |= CWWidth;
5019 if (height != XINT (bar->height))
5020 mask |= CWHeight;
5022 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5024 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5025 if (mask)
5027 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5028 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5029 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5030 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5031 left, top, width, height, False);
5032 #ifdef USE_GTK
5033 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5034 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
5035 top,
5036 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5037 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5038 max (height, 1));
5039 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5040 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5041 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5042 top,
5043 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5044 max (height, 1), 0);
5045 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5047 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5049 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5050 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5051 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5053 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5054 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5055 height, False);
5056 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5057 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5058 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5059 height, False);
5062 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5063 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5064 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5065 example. */
5067 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5068 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5069 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5071 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5072 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5073 left + area_width - rest, top,
5074 rest, height, False);
5075 else
5076 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5077 left, top, rest, height, False);
5081 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5082 if (mask)
5084 XWindowChanges wc;
5086 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5087 wc.y = top;
5088 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5089 wc.height = height;
5090 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
5091 mask, &wc);
5094 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5096 /* Remember new settings. */
5097 XSETINT (bar->left, sb_left);
5098 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
5099 XSETINT (bar->width, sb_width);
5100 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
5102 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5105 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5106 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5107 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5108 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5109 dragged. */
5110 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5112 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5114 if (whole == 0)
5115 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5116 else
5118 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5119 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5120 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5123 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5125 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
5129 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5130 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5131 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5132 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5133 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5134 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5135 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5137 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5138 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5139 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5141 static void
5142 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (frame)
5143 FRAME_PTR frame;
5145 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5146 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5148 Lisp_Object bar;
5149 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5150 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
5151 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5152 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5153 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5154 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5155 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
5160 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5161 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5163 static void
5164 XTredeem_scroll_bar (window)
5165 struct window *window;
5167 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5168 struct frame *f;
5170 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5171 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5172 abort ();
5174 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5176 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5177 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5178 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5180 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5181 the lists. */
5182 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5183 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5184 return;
5185 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5186 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5187 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
5188 else
5189 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5190 one or the other! */
5191 abort ();
5193 else
5194 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5196 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5197 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5199 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5200 bar->prev = Qnil;
5201 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5202 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5203 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5206 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5207 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5209 static void
5210 XTjudge_scroll_bars (f)
5211 FRAME_PTR f;
5213 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5215 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5217 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5218 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5219 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
5221 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5223 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5225 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5227 next = b->next;
5228 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5231 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5232 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5236 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5237 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5238 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5240 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5241 mark bits. */
5243 static void
5244 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, event)
5245 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5246 XEvent *event;
5248 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
5249 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5250 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5251 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5253 BLOCK_INPUT;
5255 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, XINT (bar->start), XINT (bar->end), 1);
5257 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5258 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5260 /* x, y, width, height */
5261 0, 0,
5262 XINT (bar->width) - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5263 XINT (bar->height) - 1);
5265 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5268 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5270 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5271 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5273 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5274 mark bits. */
5277 static void
5278 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, event, emacs_event)
5279 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5280 XEvent *event;
5281 struct input_event *emacs_event;
5283 if (! GC_WINDOWP (bar->window))
5284 abort ();
5286 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5287 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5288 emacs_event->modifiers
5289 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5290 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5291 event->xbutton.state)
5292 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5293 ? up_modifier
5294 : down_modifier));
5295 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5296 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5297 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5299 #if 0
5300 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5301 int internal_height
5302 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
5303 #endif
5304 int top_range
5305 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
5306 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5308 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5309 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5311 if (y < XINT (bar->start))
5312 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5313 else if (y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5314 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5315 else
5316 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5318 /* Just because the user has clicked on the handle doesn't mean
5319 they want to drag it. Lisp code needs to be able to decide
5320 whether or not we're dragging. */
5321 #if 0
5322 /* If the user has just clicked on the handle, record where they're
5323 holding it. */
5324 if (event->type == ButtonPress
5325 && emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
5326 XSETINT (bar->dragging, y - XINT (bar->start));
5327 #endif
5329 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5330 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5331 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5332 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5334 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5335 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
5337 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5338 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5340 #endif
5342 /* Same deal here as the other #if 0. */
5343 #if 0
5344 /* Clicks on the handle are always reported as occurring at the top of
5345 the handle. */
5346 if (emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
5347 emacs_event->x = bar->start;
5348 else
5349 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5350 #else
5351 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5352 #endif
5354 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5358 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5360 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5362 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5363 mark bits. */
5365 static void
5366 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, event)
5367 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5368 XEvent *event;
5370 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5372 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5374 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5375 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5377 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5378 if (! GC_NILP (bar->dragging))
5380 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5381 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5383 if (new_start != XINT (bar->start))
5385 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
5387 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5392 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5394 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5395 on the scroll bar. */
5397 static void
5398 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
5399 FRAME_PTR *fp;
5400 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
5401 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
5402 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
5403 unsigned long *time;
5405 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5406 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
5407 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5408 int win_x, win_y;
5409 Window dummy_window;
5410 int dummy_coord;
5411 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5413 BLOCK_INPUT;
5415 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5416 report that. */
5417 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5419 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5420 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5421 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5423 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5424 &win_x, &win_y,
5426 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5427 &dummy_mask))
5429 else
5431 #if 0
5432 int inside_height
5433 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
5434 #endif
5435 int top_range
5436 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
5438 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5440 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5441 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5443 if (win_y < 0)
5444 win_y = 0;
5445 if (win_y > top_range)
5446 win_y = top_range;
5448 *fp = f;
5449 *bar_window = bar->window;
5451 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5452 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5453 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->start))
5454 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5455 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5456 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5457 else
5458 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5460 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5461 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5463 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5464 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5467 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
5469 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5473 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5474 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5475 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5476 redraw them. */
5478 void
5479 x_scroll_bar_clear (f)
5480 FRAME_PTR f;
5482 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5483 Lisp_Object bar;
5485 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5486 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5487 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5488 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5489 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5490 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5491 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5492 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)),
5493 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5494 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5498 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5500 #if 0
5501 /* Time stamp of enter window event. This is only used by XTread_socket,
5502 but we have to put it out here, since static variables within functions
5503 sometimes don't work. */
5505 static Time enter_timestamp;
5506 #endif
5508 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5509 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5510 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5511 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5513 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5514 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5516 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5518 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5519 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5521 static int temp_index;
5522 static short temp_buffer[100];
5524 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5525 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5526 temp_index = 0; \
5527 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5529 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5530 on a particular display. */
5532 struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5534 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5535 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5536 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5537 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5539 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5541 #define SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT(size) \
5542 do \
5544 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5545 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
5546 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5547 bcopy (&event, f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event, size); \
5548 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5549 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5551 while (0)
5553 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XButtonEvent))
5554 #define SET_SAVED_KEY_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XKeyEvent))
5557 enum
5559 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5560 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5561 X_EVENT_DROP
5564 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5565 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5566 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5568 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5569 this event further.
5570 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5572 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5573 static int
5574 x_filter_event (dpyinfo, event)
5575 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5576 XEvent *event;
5578 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5579 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5580 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5581 was created. */
5583 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5584 event->xclient.window);
5586 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5588 #endif
5590 #ifdef USE_GTK
5591 static int current_count;
5592 static int current_finish;
5593 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5595 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5596 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5597 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5598 static GdkFilterReturn
5599 event_handler_gdk (gxev, ev, data)
5600 GdkXEvent *gxev;
5601 GdkEvent *ev;
5602 gpointer data;
5604 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5606 if (current_count >= 0)
5608 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5610 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5612 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5613 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5614 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5615 so we do it here. */
5616 if (xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5617 if (dpyinfo && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5618 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5619 #endif
5621 if (! dpyinfo)
5622 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5623 else
5625 current_count +=
5626 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5627 current_hold_quit);
5630 else
5631 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5633 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5634 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5636 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5638 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5641 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5643 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5644 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5645 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5647 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5649 static int
5650 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, eventp, finish, hold_quit)
5651 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5652 XEvent *eventp;
5653 int *finish;
5654 struct input_event *hold_quit;
5656 union {
5657 struct input_event ie;
5658 struct selection_input_event sie;
5659 } inev;
5660 int count = 0;
5661 int do_help = 0;
5662 int nbytes = 0;
5663 struct frame *f;
5664 struct coding_system coding;
5665 XEvent event = *eventp;
5667 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5669 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
5670 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
5671 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
5673 switch (event.type)
5675 case ClientMessage:
5677 if (event.xclient.message_type
5678 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5679 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5681 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5682 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5684 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5685 could be the shell widget window
5686 if the frame has no title bar. */
5687 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5688 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5689 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5690 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5691 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5692 #endif
5693 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5694 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5695 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5696 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5697 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5698 needed.
5700 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5701 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5702 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5703 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5704 Emacs. */
5706 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5707 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5708 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5709 if (f)
5711 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5712 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5713 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5714 int count = x_catch_errors (d);
5715 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5716 /* The ICCCM says this is
5717 the only valid choice. */
5718 RevertToParent,
5719 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5720 /* This is needed to detect the error
5721 if there is an error. */
5722 XSync (d, False);
5723 x_uncatch_errors (d, count);
5725 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5726 #endif /* 0 */
5727 goto done;
5730 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5731 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5733 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5734 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5735 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5736 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5737 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5738 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5739 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5740 session manager and one for this. */
5741 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5742 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5743 #endif
5745 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5746 event.xclient.window);
5747 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5748 for a single Emacs process. */
5749 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5750 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5751 event.xclient.window,
5752 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5753 else if (f)
5754 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5755 event.xclient.window,
5756 0, 0);
5758 goto done;
5761 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5762 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5764 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5765 event.xclient.window);
5766 if (!f)
5767 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5769 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5770 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
5771 goto done;
5774 goto done;
5777 if (event.xclient.message_type
5778 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5780 goto done;
5783 if (event.xclient.message_type
5784 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5786 int new_x, new_y;
5787 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5789 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
5790 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
5792 if (f)
5794 f->left_pos = new_x;
5795 f->top_pos = new_y;
5797 goto done;
5800 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
5801 if (event.xclient.message_type
5802 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
5804 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5805 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
5806 &event, NULL);
5807 goto done;
5809 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
5811 if ((event.xclient.message_type
5812 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
5813 || (event.xclient.message_type
5814 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
5816 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
5817 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
5818 currently never do because we are interested in
5819 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
5820 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
5821 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5822 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
5823 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
5824 goto done;
5827 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5828 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
5829 we construct an input_event. */
5830 if (event.xclient.message_type
5831 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
5833 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
5834 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
5835 goto done;
5837 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5839 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5841 if (!f)
5842 goto OTHER;
5844 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
5845 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
5847 break;
5849 case SelectionNotify:
5850 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5851 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
5852 goto OTHER;
5853 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5854 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
5855 break;
5857 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
5858 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5859 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
5860 goto OTHER;
5861 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5863 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = (XSelectionClearEvent *) &event;
5865 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
5866 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
5867 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
5868 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
5869 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
5871 break;
5873 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
5874 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5875 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
5876 goto OTHER;
5877 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5879 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp
5880 = (XSelectionRequestEvent *) &event;
5882 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
5883 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
5884 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
5885 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
5886 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
5887 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
5888 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
5889 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
5891 break;
5893 case PropertyNotify:
5894 #if 0 /* This is plain wrong. In the case that we are waiting for a
5895 PropertyNotify used as an ACK in incremental selection
5896 transfer, the property will be on the receiver's window. */
5897 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
5898 if (!x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window))
5899 goto OTHER;
5900 #endif
5901 #endif
5902 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
5903 goto OTHER;
5905 case ReparentNotify:
5906 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
5907 if (f)
5909 int x, y;
5910 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
5911 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
5912 f->left_pos = x;
5913 f->top_pos = y;
5915 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
5916 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
5918 goto OTHER;
5920 case Expose:
5921 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
5922 if (f)
5924 x_check_fullscreen (f);
5926 #ifdef USE_GTK
5927 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
5928 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
5929 event.xexpose.window,
5930 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
5931 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
5932 FALSE);
5933 #endif
5934 if (f->async_visible == 0)
5936 f->async_visible = 1;
5937 f->async_iconified = 0;
5938 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
5939 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
5941 else
5942 expose_frame (f,
5943 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
5944 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
5946 else
5948 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5949 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5950 #endif
5951 #if defined USE_LUCID
5952 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
5953 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
5954 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
5956 Widget widget
5957 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
5958 if (widget)
5959 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
5961 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
5963 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5964 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
5965 goto OTHER;
5966 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5967 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
5968 event.xexpose.window);
5970 if (bar)
5971 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
5972 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5973 else
5974 goto OTHER;
5975 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5976 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5978 break;
5980 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
5981 source area was obscured or not
5982 available. */
5983 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
5984 if (f)
5986 expose_frame (f,
5987 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
5988 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
5989 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
5991 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5992 else
5993 goto OTHER;
5994 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5995 break;
5997 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
5998 source area was completely
5999 available. */
6000 break;
6002 case UnmapNotify:
6003 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6004 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6006 tip_window = 0;
6007 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6010 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6011 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6012 the frame was deleted. */
6014 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6015 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6016 display that won't ever be seen. */
6017 f->async_visible = 0;
6018 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6019 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6020 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6021 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6022 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6023 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6024 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6026 f->async_iconified = 1;
6028 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6029 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6032 goto OTHER;
6034 case MapNotify:
6035 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6036 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6037 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6038 goto OTHER;
6040 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6041 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6042 frame is visible. */
6043 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6044 if (f)
6046 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6047 the frame's display structures.
6048 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6049 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6050 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6051 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6052 if (! f->async_iconified)
6053 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6055 f->async_visible = 1;
6056 f->async_iconified = 0;
6057 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6059 if (f->iconified)
6061 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6062 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6064 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6065 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6066 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6067 to update the frame titles
6068 in case this is the second frame. */
6069 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6071 goto OTHER;
6073 case KeyPress:
6075 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6077 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6078 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6079 if (popup_activated ())
6080 goto OTHER;
6081 #endif
6083 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6085 if (!dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight))
6087 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6088 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6091 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6092 if (f == 0)
6094 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6095 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6096 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6097 event.xkey.window);
6098 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6100 widget = XtParent (widget);
6101 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6104 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6106 if (f != 0)
6108 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6109 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6110 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6111 his Emacs hang.
6113 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6114 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6115 status_return even if the input is too long to
6116 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6117 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6118 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6119 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6120 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6121 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6122 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6123 int modifiers;
6124 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6125 Lisp_Object c;
6127 #ifdef USE_GTK
6128 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6129 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6130 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6131 (see above). */
6132 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6133 #endif
6135 event.xkey.state
6136 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6137 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6138 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6140 /* This will have to go some day... */
6142 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6143 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6144 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6145 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6146 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6147 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6148 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6150 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6151 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6152 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6153 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6154 not it is combined with Meta. */
6155 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6156 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6158 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6159 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6161 Status status_return;
6163 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6164 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6165 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6166 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6167 &status_return);
6168 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6170 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6171 copy_bufptr = (unsigned char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6172 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6173 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6174 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6175 &status_return);
6177 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6178 #if 0 && defined X_HAVE_UTF8_STRING
6179 else if (status_return == XLookupKeySym)
6180 { /* Try again but with utf-8. */
6181 coding_system = Qutf_8;
6182 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6183 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6184 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6185 &status_return);
6186 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6188 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6189 copy_bufptr = (unsigned char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6190 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6191 &event.xkey,
6192 copy_bufptr,
6193 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6194 &status_return);
6197 #endif
6199 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6200 break;
6201 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6203 keysym = NoSymbol;
6204 modifiers = 0;
6206 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6207 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6208 abort ();
6210 else
6211 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6212 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6213 &compose_status);
6214 #else
6215 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6216 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6217 &compose_status);
6218 #endif
6220 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6221 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6222 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6223 break;
6225 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6226 orig_keysym = keysym;
6228 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6229 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6230 inev.ie.modifiers
6231 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6232 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6234 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6235 translations to characters. */
6236 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6237 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6239 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6240 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6241 goto done_keysym;
6244 /* Keysyms directly mapped to supported Unicode characters. */
6245 if ((keysym >= 0x01000100 && keysym <= 0x010033ff)
6246 || (keysym >= 0x0100e000 && keysym <= 0x0100ffff))
6248 int code, charset_id, c1, c2;
6250 if (keysym < 0x01002500)
6251 charset_id = charset_mule_unicode_0100_24ff,
6252 code = (keysym & 0xFFFF) - 0x100;
6253 else if (keysym < 0x0100e000)
6254 charset_id = charset_mule_unicode_2500_33ff,
6255 code = (keysym & 0xFFFF) - 0x2500;
6256 else
6257 charset_id = charset_mule_unicode_e000_ffff,
6258 code = (keysym & 0xFFFF) - 0xe000;
6259 c1 = (code / 96) + 32, c2 = (code % 96) + 32;
6260 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6261 inev.ie.code = MAKE_CHAR (charset_id, c1, c2);
6262 goto done_keysym;
6265 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6266 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6267 && (NATNUMP (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6268 Vx_keysym_table,
6269 Qnil))))
6271 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6272 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6273 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6274 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6275 goto done_keysym;
6278 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6279 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6280 || keysym == XK_Delete
6281 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6282 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6283 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6284 #endif
6285 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6286 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6287 #ifdef HPUX
6288 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6289 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6290 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6291 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6292 || ((unsigned) (keysym) >= XK_Select
6293 && (unsigned)(keysym) < XK_KP_Space)
6294 #endif
6295 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6296 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6297 #endif
6298 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6299 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6300 #endif
6301 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6302 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6303 #endif
6304 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6305 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6306 #endif
6307 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6308 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6309 #endif
6310 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6311 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6312 #endif
6313 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6314 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6315 #endif
6316 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6317 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6318 #endif
6319 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6320 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6321 #endif
6322 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6323 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6324 #endif
6325 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6326 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6327 #endif
6328 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6329 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6330 #endif
6331 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6332 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6333 #endif
6334 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6335 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6336 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6337 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6338 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6339 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6340 #ifndef HAVE_X11R5
6341 #ifdef XK_Mode_switch
6342 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Mode_switch)
6343 #endif
6344 #ifdef XK_Num_Lock
6345 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Num_Lock)
6346 #endif
6347 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R5 */
6348 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6349 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6350 don't have real modifiers but
6351 should be treated similarly to
6352 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6353 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6354 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6355 >= XK_ISO_Lock
6356 && (unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6357 <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6358 #endif
6361 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6362 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6363 key. */
6364 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6365 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6366 goto done_keysym;
6369 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6370 register int i;
6371 register int c;
6372 int nchars, len;
6374 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6375 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6376 we used just above and the locale. */
6377 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6378 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6379 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6380 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6381 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6382 gives us composition information. */
6383 coding.composing = COMPOSITION_DISABLED;
6385 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6387 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6391 /* Decode the input data. */
6392 int require;
6393 unsigned char *p;
6395 require = decoding_buffer_size (&coding, nbytes);
6396 p = (unsigned char *) alloca (require);
6397 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6398 /* We explicitly disable composition handling because
6399 key data should not contain any composition sequence. */
6400 coding.composing = COMPOSITION_DISABLED;
6401 decode_coding (&coding, copy_bufptr, p, nbytes, require);
6402 nbytes = coding.produced;
6403 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6404 copy_bufptr = p;
6407 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6408 character events. */
6409 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6411 if (nchars == nbytes)
6412 c = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6413 else
6414 c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i,
6415 nbytes - i, len);
6416 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (c)
6417 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6418 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6419 inev.ie.code = c;
6420 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6423 /* Previous code updated count by nchars rather than nbytes,
6424 but that seems bogus to me. ++kfs */
6425 count += nbytes;
6427 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6429 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6430 break;
6433 done_keysym:
6434 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6435 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6436 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6437 client. */
6438 break;
6439 #else
6440 goto OTHER;
6441 #endif
6443 case KeyRelease:
6444 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6445 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6446 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6447 client. */
6448 break;
6449 #else
6450 goto OTHER;
6451 #endif
6453 case EnterNotify:
6454 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6456 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6458 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6459 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6461 #if 0
6462 if (event.xcrossing.focus)
6464 /* Avoid nasty pop/raise loops. */
6465 if (f && (!(f->auto_raise)
6466 || !(f->auto_lower)
6467 || (event.xcrossing.time - enter_timestamp) > 500))
6469 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, f);
6470 enter_timestamp = event.xcrossing.time;
6473 else if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6474 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
6475 #endif
6477 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6478 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6479 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6480 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6481 goto OTHER;
6483 case FocusIn:
6484 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6485 goto OTHER;
6487 case LeaveNotify:
6488 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6490 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6491 if (f)
6493 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6495 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6496 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6497 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6498 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6501 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6502 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6503 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6504 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6505 if (any_help_event_p)
6506 do_help = -1;
6508 goto OTHER;
6510 case FocusOut:
6511 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6512 goto OTHER;
6514 case MotionNotify:
6516 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6517 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6519 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6520 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6521 f = last_mouse_frame;
6522 else
6523 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6525 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6527 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6528 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6531 if (f)
6534 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed. */
6535 if (mouse_autoselect_window)
6537 Lisp_Object window;
6539 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6540 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6541 0, 0, 0, 0);
6543 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6544 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6545 will be selected iff it is active. */
6546 if (WINDOWP (window)
6547 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6548 && !EQ (window, selected_window))
6550 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6551 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6554 last_window=window;
6556 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion))
6557 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
6559 else
6561 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6562 struct scroll_bar *bar
6563 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6564 event.xmotion.window);
6566 if (bar)
6567 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6568 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6570 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6571 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6572 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6575 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6576 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6577 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6578 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6579 do_help = 1;
6580 goto OTHER;
6583 case ConfigureNotify:
6584 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6585 if (f)
6587 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6588 #ifdef USE_GTK
6589 xg_resize_widgets (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6590 event.xconfigure.height);
6591 #else /* not USE_GTK */
6592 /* If there is a pending resize for fullscreen, don't
6593 do this one, the right one will come later.
6594 The toolkit version doesn't seem to need this, but we
6595 need to reset it below. */
6596 int dont_resize
6597 = ((f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
6598 && f->new_text_cols != 0);
6599 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6600 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6602 if (dont_resize)
6603 goto OTHER;
6605 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6606 is called by the code that handles resizing
6607 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6609 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6610 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6611 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6612 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6613 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6614 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6615 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6617 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6618 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6619 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6621 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6622 #endif
6624 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6625 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6627 #ifdef USE_GTK
6628 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6629 Only get real positions and check fullscreen when mapped. */
6630 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6631 && GTK_WIDGET_MAPPED (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6632 #endif
6634 /* What we have now is the position of Emacs's own window.
6635 Convert that to the position of the window manager window. */
6636 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6638 x_check_expected_move (f);
6639 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
6640 f->want_fullscreen &= ~(FULLSCREEN_WAIT|FULLSCREEN_BOTH);
6643 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6644 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6645 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6646 #endif
6648 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
6650 /* Since the WM decorations come below top_pos now,
6651 we must put them below top_pos in the future. */
6652 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
6653 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
6656 goto OTHER;
6658 case ButtonRelease:
6659 case ButtonPress:
6661 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6662 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6663 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6665 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6666 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
6668 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6669 && last_mouse_frame
6670 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6671 f = last_mouse_frame;
6672 else
6673 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6675 if (f)
6677 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6678 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6679 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6681 Lisp_Object window;
6682 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6683 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6685 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 0, 0, 1);
6686 if (EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window))
6688 if (event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress)
6689 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y, 1, 0);
6690 else
6691 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y, 0,
6692 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6693 event.xbutton.state));
6694 tool_bar_p = 1;
6698 if (!tool_bar_p)
6699 if (!dpyinfo->x_focus_frame
6700 || f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6702 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6703 if (! popup_activated ())
6704 #endif
6706 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6708 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6709 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6711 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6712 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6714 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6715 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6717 else
6718 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6722 else
6724 struct scroll_bar *bar
6725 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6726 event.xbutton.window);
6728 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6729 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6730 scroll bars. */
6731 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6733 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6734 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6736 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6737 if (bar)
6738 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6739 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6742 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6744 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6745 last_mouse_frame = f;
6747 if (!tool_bar_p)
6748 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6750 else
6751 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6753 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6754 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6755 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6756 if (f != 0)
6757 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6759 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6760 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6761 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6762 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6763 Instead, save it away
6764 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6765 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6766 if (
6767 #ifdef USE_GTK
6768 ! popup_activated ()
6770 #endif
6771 f && event.type == ButtonPress
6772 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6773 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6774 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6775 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6776 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6777 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6778 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6780 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6781 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
6782 #ifdef USE_GTK
6783 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6784 #endif
6786 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6788 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
6789 goto OTHER;
6792 #ifdef USE_MOTIF /* This should do not harm for Lucid,
6793 but I am trying to be cautious. */
6794 else if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6796 if (!NILP (last_mouse_press_frame))
6798 f = XFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame);
6799 if (f->output_data.x)
6800 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6802 else
6803 goto OTHER;
6805 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
6806 else
6807 goto OTHER;
6808 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6810 break;
6812 case CirculateNotify:
6813 goto OTHER;
6815 case CirculateRequest:
6816 goto OTHER;
6818 case VisibilityNotify:
6819 goto OTHER;
6821 case MappingNotify:
6822 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
6823 local cache. */
6824 switch (event.xmapping.request)
6826 case MappingModifier:
6827 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
6828 /* This is meant to fall through. */
6829 case MappingKeyboard:
6830 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
6832 goto OTHER;
6834 default:
6835 OTHER:
6836 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6837 BLOCK_INPUT;
6838 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
6839 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
6840 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6841 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6842 break;
6845 done:
6846 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
6848 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6849 count++;
6852 if (do_help
6853 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
6855 Lisp_Object frame;
6857 if (f)
6858 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
6859 else
6860 frame = Qnil;
6862 if (do_help > 0)
6864 any_help_event_p = 1;
6865 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
6866 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
6868 else
6870 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6871 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
6873 count++;
6876 *eventp = event;
6877 return count;
6881 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
6882 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
6883 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
6885 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
6887 x_dispatch_event (event, display)
6888 XEvent *event;
6889 Display *display;
6891 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6892 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
6894 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
6896 if (dpyinfo)
6897 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
6899 return finish;
6903 /* Read events coming from the X server.
6904 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler.
6905 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
6907 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
6908 thus pretending to be `read'.
6910 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
6912 static int
6913 XTread_socket (sd, expected, hold_quit)
6914 register int sd;
6915 int expected;
6916 struct input_event *hold_quit;
6918 int count = 0;
6919 XEvent event;
6920 int event_found = 0;
6921 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6923 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
6925 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
6926 return -1;
6929 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
6930 BLOCK_INPUT;
6932 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
6933 input_signal_count++;
6935 ++handling_signal;
6937 /* Find the display we are supposed to read input for.
6938 It's the one communicating on descriptor SD. */
6939 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
6941 #if 0 /* This ought to be unnecessary; let's verify it. */
6942 #ifdef FIOSNBIO
6943 /* If available, Xlib uses FIOSNBIO to make the socket
6944 non-blocking, and then looks for EWOULDBLOCK. If O_NDELAY is set,
6945 FIOSNBIO is ignored, and instead of signaling EWOULDBLOCK,
6946 a read returns 0, which Xlib interprets as equivalent to EPIPE. */
6947 fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_SETFL, 0);
6948 #endif /* ! defined (FIOSNBIO) */
6949 #endif
6951 #if 0 /* This code can't be made to work, with multiple displays,
6952 and appears not to be used on any system any more.
6953 Also keyboard.c doesn't turn O_NDELAY on and off
6954 for X connections. */
6955 #ifndef SIGIO
6956 #ifndef HAVE_SELECT
6957 if (! (fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_GETFL, 0) & O_NDELAY))
6959 extern int read_alarm_should_throw;
6960 read_alarm_should_throw = 1;
6961 XPeekEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
6962 read_alarm_should_throw = 0;
6964 #endif /* HAVE_SELECT */
6965 #endif /* SIGIO */
6966 #endif
6968 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
6969 if (dpyinfo == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
6971 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
6972 x_io_error_quitter (dpyinfo->display);
6975 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
6977 struct input_event inev;
6978 BLOCK_INPUT;
6979 /* We don't need to EVENT_INIT (inev) here, as
6980 x_session_check_input copies an entire input_event. */
6981 if (x_session_check_input (&inev))
6983 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev, hold_quit);
6984 count++;
6986 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6988 #endif
6990 #ifndef USE_GTK
6991 while (XPending (dpyinfo->display))
6993 int finish;
6995 XNextEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
6997 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6998 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
6999 if (x_filter_event (dpyinfo, &event))
7000 break;
7001 #endif
7002 event_found = 1;
7004 count += handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7006 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7007 goto out;
7009 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
7012 #ifdef USE_GTK
7014 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7015 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7016 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7017 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7019 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7020 from all displays. */
7022 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7024 current_count = count;
7025 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7027 gtk_main_iteration ();
7029 count = current_count;
7030 current_count = -1;
7031 current_hold_quit = 0;
7033 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7034 break;
7036 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7038 out:;
7040 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7041 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7042 if (! event_found)
7044 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7045 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7046 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7047 x_noop_count++;
7048 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7050 x_noop_count=0;
7052 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7053 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7055 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7057 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7058 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7062 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7063 raise it now. */
7064 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7065 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7067 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7068 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7071 --handling_signal;
7072 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7074 return count;
7080 /***********************************************************************
7081 Text Cursor
7082 ***********************************************************************/
7084 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7085 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7087 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7088 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7089 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7091 static void
7092 x_clip_to_row (w, row, area, gc)
7093 struct window *w;
7094 struct glyph_row *row;
7095 int area;
7096 GC gc;
7098 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7099 XRectangle clip_rect;
7100 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7102 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7104 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7105 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7106 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7107 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7108 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7110 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7114 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7116 static void
7117 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, row)
7118 struct window *w;
7119 struct glyph_row *row;
7121 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7122 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7123 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7124 int x, y, wd, h;
7125 XGCValues xgcv;
7126 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7127 GC gc;
7129 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7130 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7131 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7132 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7133 return;
7135 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7136 x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7137 y = get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &h);
7138 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7140 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7141 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7142 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7143 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7144 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7145 else
7146 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7147 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7148 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7150 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7151 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7152 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h);
7153 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7157 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7159 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7160 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7161 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7162 --gerd. */
7164 static void
7165 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, row, width, kind)
7166 struct window *w;
7167 struct glyph_row *row;
7168 int width;
7169 enum text_cursor_kinds kind;
7171 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7172 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7174 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7175 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7176 and mini-buffer. */
7177 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7178 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7179 return;
7181 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7182 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7183 the bar might not be in the window. */
7184 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7186 struct glyph_row *row;
7187 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7188 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7190 else
7192 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7193 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7194 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7195 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7196 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7197 XGCValues xgcv;
7199 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7200 the bar cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7201 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7202 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7203 that the glyph is legible. */
7204 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7205 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7206 else
7207 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7208 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7210 if (gc)
7211 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7212 else
7214 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7215 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7218 if (width < 0)
7219 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7220 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7222 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7223 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7225 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7226 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7227 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7228 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7229 width, row->height);
7230 else
7231 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7232 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7233 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7234 row->height - width),
7235 cursor_glyph->pixel_width,
7236 width);
7238 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7243 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7245 static void
7246 x_define_frame_cursor (f, cursor)
7247 struct frame *f;
7248 Cursor cursor;
7250 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7254 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7256 static void
7257 x_clear_frame_area (f, x, y, width, height)
7258 struct frame *f;
7259 int x, y, width, height;
7261 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7262 x, y, width, height, False);
7266 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7268 static void
7269 x_draw_window_cursor (w, glyph_row, x, y, cursor_type, cursor_width, on_p, active_p)
7270 struct window *w;
7271 struct glyph_row *glyph_row;
7272 int x, y;
7273 int cursor_type, cursor_width;
7274 int on_p, active_p;
7276 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7278 if (on_p)
7280 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7281 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7283 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7284 && w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])
7286 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7287 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, 0);
7289 else
7290 switch (cursor_type)
7292 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7293 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7294 break;
7296 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7297 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7298 break;
7300 case BAR_CURSOR:
7301 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7302 break;
7304 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7305 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7306 break;
7308 case NO_CURSOR:
7309 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7310 break;
7312 default:
7313 abort ();
7316 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7317 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7318 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7319 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7320 #endif
7323 #ifndef XFlush
7324 if (updating_frame != f)
7325 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7326 #endif
7330 /* Icons. */
7332 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7335 x_bitmap_icon (f, file)
7336 struct frame *f;
7337 Lisp_Object file;
7339 int bitmap_id;
7341 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7342 return 1;
7344 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7345 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7346 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7347 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7349 if (STRINGP (file))
7351 #ifdef USE_GTK
7352 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7353 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7354 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7355 return 0;
7356 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7357 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7358 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7360 else
7362 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7363 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7365 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id
7366 = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, gnu_bits,
7367 gnu_width, gnu_height);
7368 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7371 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7372 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7373 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7374 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7375 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7377 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7380 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7381 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7383 return 0;
7387 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7388 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7391 x_text_icon (f, icon_name)
7392 struct frame *f;
7393 char *icon_name;
7395 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7396 return 1;
7398 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
7400 XTextProperty text;
7401 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7402 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7403 text.format = 8;
7404 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7405 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7407 #else /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
7408 XSetIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), icon_name);
7409 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
7411 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7412 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7413 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7414 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7416 return 0;
7419 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7421 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7422 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string. */
7424 static Lisp_Object x_error_message_string;
7426 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7427 x_error_message_string. This is called from x_error_handler if
7428 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7430 static void
7431 x_error_catcher (display, error)
7432 Display *display;
7433 XErrorEvent *error;
7435 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code,
7436 SDATA (x_error_message_string),
7437 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7440 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7441 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7442 operating on.
7444 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7445 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7446 stored in x_error_message_string.
7448 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7449 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7451 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7453 void x_check_errors ();
7454 static Lisp_Object x_catch_errors_unwind ();
7457 x_catch_errors (dpy)
7458 Display *dpy;
7460 int count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7462 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7463 XSync (dpy, False);
7465 record_unwind_protect (x_catch_errors_unwind,
7466 Fcons (make_save_value (dpy, 0),
7467 x_error_message_string));
7469 x_error_message_string = make_uninit_string (X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7470 SSET (x_error_message_string, 0, 0);
7472 return count;
7475 /* Unbind the binding that we made to check for X errors. */
7477 static Lisp_Object
7478 x_catch_errors_unwind (old_val)
7479 Lisp_Object old_val;
7481 Lisp_Object first = XCAR (old_val);
7482 Display *dpy = XSAVE_VALUE (first)->pointer;
7484 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7485 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7486 if (x_display_info_for_display (dpy) != 0)
7488 BLOCK_INPUT;
7489 XSync (dpy, False);
7490 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7493 x_error_message_string = XCDR (old_val);
7494 return Qnil;
7497 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7498 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7499 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7501 void
7502 x_check_errors (dpy, format)
7503 Display *dpy;
7504 char *format;
7506 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7507 XSync (dpy, False);
7509 if (SREF (x_error_message_string, 0))
7510 error (format, SDATA (x_error_message_string));
7513 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7514 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7517 x_had_errors_p (dpy)
7518 Display *dpy;
7520 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7521 XSync (dpy, False);
7523 return SREF (x_error_message_string, 0) != 0;
7526 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7528 void
7529 x_clear_errors (dpy)
7530 Display *dpy;
7532 SSET (x_error_message_string, 0, 0);
7535 /* Stop catching X protocol errors and let them make Emacs die.
7536 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors.
7537 COUNT should be the value that was returned by
7538 the corresponding call to x_catch_errors. */
7540 void
7541 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count)
7542 Display *dpy;
7543 int count;
7545 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
7548 #if 0
7549 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7550 x_trace_wire ()
7552 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7554 #endif /* ! 0 */
7557 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7558 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7559 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7560 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7561 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7563 static SIGTYPE
7564 x_connection_signal (signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7565 int signalnum; /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7567 #ifdef USG
7568 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7569 must reestablish each time */
7570 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
7571 #endif /* USG */
7575 /************************************************************************
7576 Handling X errors
7577 ************************************************************************/
7579 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7581 static char *error_msg;
7583 /* Function installed as fatal_error_signal_hook in
7584 x_connection_closed. Print the X error message, and exit normally,
7585 instead of dumping core when XtCloseDisplay fails. */
7587 static void
7588 x_fatal_error_signal ()
7590 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7591 exit (70);
7594 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7595 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7597 static SIGTYPE
7598 x_connection_closed (dpy, error_message)
7599 Display *dpy;
7600 char *error_message;
7602 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7603 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7604 int count;
7606 error_msg = (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7607 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7608 handling_signal = 0;
7610 /* Prevent being called recursively because of an error condition
7611 below. Otherwise, we might end up with printing ``can't find per
7612 display information'' in the recursive call instead of printing
7613 the original message here. */
7614 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
7616 /* We have to close the display to inform Xt that it doesn't
7617 exist anymore. If we don't, Xt will continue to wait for
7618 events from the display. As a consequence, a sequence of
7620 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7621 ...kill the new frame, so that we get an IO error...
7622 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7624 will indefinitely wait in Xt for events for display `:1', opened
7625 in the first class to make-frame-on-display.
7627 Closing the display is reported to lead to a bus error on
7628 OpenWindows in certain situations. I suspect that is a bug
7629 in OpenWindows. I don't know how to cicumvent it here. */
7631 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7632 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display
7633 in the first place, so don't try to close it. */
7634 if (dpyinfo)
7636 extern void (*fatal_error_signal_hook) P_ ((void));
7637 fatal_error_signal_hook = x_fatal_error_signal;
7638 XtCloseDisplay (dpy);
7639 fatal_error_signal_hook = NULL;
7641 #endif
7643 #ifdef USE_GTK
7644 if (dpyinfo)
7645 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
7646 #endif
7648 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7649 if (dpyinfo)
7650 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7652 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7653 that are on the dead display. */
7654 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7656 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7657 minibuf_frame
7658 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7659 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7660 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7661 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7662 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7663 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
7666 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7667 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7668 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7669 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7670 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7671 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7673 /* Set this to t so that Fdelete_frame won't get confused
7674 trying to find a replacement. */
7675 FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame))->Vdefault_minibuffer_frame = Qt;
7676 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
7679 if (dpyinfo)
7680 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
7682 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
7684 if (x_display_list == 0)
7686 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7687 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
7688 exit (70);
7691 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7692 #ifdef SIGIO
7693 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
7694 #endif
7695 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
7696 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7698 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7699 error ("%s", error_msg);
7702 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7703 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7704 static void x_error_quitter (Display *display, XErrorEvent *error);
7706 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7707 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7709 static int
7710 x_error_handler (display, error)
7711 Display *display;
7712 XErrorEvent *error;
7714 if (! NILP (x_error_message_string))
7715 x_error_catcher (display, error);
7716 else
7717 x_error_quitter (display, error);
7718 return 0;
7721 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7722 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7723 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7725 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7727 #if __GNUC__ >= 3 /* On GCC 3.0 we might get a warning. */
7728 #define NO_INLINE __attribute__((noinline))
7729 #else
7730 #define NO_INLINE
7731 #endif
7733 /* Some versions of GNU/Linux define noinline in their headers. */
7735 #ifdef noinline
7736 #undef noinline
7737 #endif
7739 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7740 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7742 static void NO_INLINE
7743 x_error_quitter (display, error)
7744 Display *display;
7745 XErrorEvent *error;
7747 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7749 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7750 original error handler. */
7752 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7753 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7754 buf, error->request_code);
7755 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7759 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7760 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7761 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7763 static int
7764 x_io_error_quitter (display)
7765 Display *display;
7767 char buf[256];
7769 sprintf (buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'", DisplayString (display));
7770 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7771 return 0;
7774 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7776 /* Give frame F the font named FONTNAME as its default font, and
7777 return the full name of that font. FONTNAME may be a wildcard
7778 pattern; in that case, we choose some font that fits the pattern.
7779 The return value shows which font we chose. */
7781 Lisp_Object
7782 x_new_font (f, fontname)
7783 struct frame *f;
7784 register char *fontname;
7786 struct font_info *fontp
7787 = FS_LOAD_FONT (f, 0, fontname, -1);
7789 if (!fontp)
7790 return Qnil;
7792 FRAME_FONT (f) = (XFontStruct *) (fontp->font);
7793 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = fontp->baseline_offset;
7794 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = -1;
7796 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = fontp->average_width;
7797 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f) = fontp->space_width;
7798 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (FRAME_FONT (f));
7800 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7802 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7803 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7805 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7806 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7807 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7809 else
7811 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7812 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7815 /* Now make the frame display the given font. */
7816 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7818 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
7819 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7820 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->reverse_gc,
7821 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7822 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->cursor_gc,
7823 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7825 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7826 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7827 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7828 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7829 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
7832 return build_string (fontp->full_name);
7835 /* Give frame F the fontset named FONTSETNAME as its default font, and
7836 return the full name of that fontset. FONTSETNAME may be a wildcard
7837 pattern; in that case, we choose some fontset that fits the pattern.
7838 The return value shows which fontset we chose. */
7840 Lisp_Object
7841 x_new_fontset (f, fontsetname)
7842 struct frame *f;
7843 char *fontsetname;
7845 int fontset = fs_query_fontset (build_string (fontsetname), 0);
7846 Lisp_Object result;
7848 if (fontset < 0)
7849 return Qnil;
7851 if (FRAME_FONTSET (f) == fontset)
7852 /* This fontset is already set in frame F. There's nothing more
7853 to do. */
7854 return fontset_name (fontset);
7856 result = x_new_font (f, (SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset))));
7858 if (!STRINGP (result))
7859 /* Can't load ASCII font. */
7860 return Qnil;
7862 /* Since x_new_font doesn't update any fontset information, do it now. */
7863 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7865 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7866 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
7867 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
7868 xic_set_xfontset (f, SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
7869 #endif
7871 return build_string (fontsetname);
7875 /***********************************************************************
7876 X Input Methods
7877 ***********************************************************************/
7879 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7881 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7883 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
7884 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
7885 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
7887 static void
7888 xim_destroy_callback (xim, client_data, call_data)
7889 XIM xim;
7890 XPointer client_data;
7891 XPointer call_data;
7893 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
7894 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7896 BLOCK_INPUT;
7898 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
7899 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7901 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
7902 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
7904 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
7905 xic_free_xfontset (f);
7909 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
7910 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
7911 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
7912 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7915 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
7917 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7918 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
7919 extern char *XSetIMValues P_ ((XIM, ...));
7920 #endif
7922 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
7923 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
7925 static void
7926 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name)
7927 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7928 char *resource_name;
7930 XIM xim;
7932 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
7933 if (use_xim)
7935 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
7936 EMACS_CLASS);
7937 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
7939 if (xim)
7941 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7942 XIMCallback destroy;
7943 #endif
7945 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
7946 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
7948 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7949 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
7950 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
7951 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
7952 #endif
7956 else
7957 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
7958 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
7962 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
7964 struct xim_inst_t
7966 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7967 char *resource_name;
7970 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
7971 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
7972 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
7973 when the callback was registered. */
7975 static void
7976 xim_instantiate_callback (display, client_data, call_data)
7977 Display *display;
7978 XPointer client_data;
7979 XPointer call_data;
7981 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
7982 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
7984 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
7985 if (dpyinfo->xim)
7986 return;
7988 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
7990 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
7991 as they have no XIC. */
7992 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
7994 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
7996 BLOCK_INPUT;
7997 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7999 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8001 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8002 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8004 create_frame_xic (f);
8005 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8006 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8007 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8009 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8010 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8015 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8019 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8022 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8023 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8024 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8025 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8027 static void
8028 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name)
8029 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8030 char *resource_name;
8032 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8033 if (use_xim)
8035 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8036 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst;
8037 int len;
8039 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8040 xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t));
8041 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8042 len = strlen (resource_name);
8043 xim_inst->resource_name = (char *) xmalloc (len + 1);
8044 bcopy (resource_name, xim_inst->resource_name, len + 1);
8045 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8046 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
8047 xim_instantiate_callback,
8048 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8049 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8050 least, hence the configure test. */
8051 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8052 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8053 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8054 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8055 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8058 else
8059 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8060 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8064 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8066 static void
8067 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo)
8068 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8070 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8071 if (use_xim)
8073 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8074 if (dpyinfo->display)
8075 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8076 NULL, EMACS_CLASS,
8077 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8078 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8079 if (dpyinfo->display)
8080 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8081 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8082 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8084 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8087 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8091 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8092 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8094 void
8095 x_calc_absolute_position (f)
8096 struct frame *f;
8098 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8100 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8101 is already for the top-left corner. */
8102 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8103 return;
8105 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8106 position that fits on the screen. */
8107 if (flags & XNegative)
8108 f->left_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width
8109 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos);
8112 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8114 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8115 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8116 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8118 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8119 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8120 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8121 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8122 is right, though.
8124 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8125 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8127 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8128 #endif
8130 if (flags & YNegative)
8131 f->top_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height - height + f->top_pos);
8134 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8135 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8136 so the flags should correspond. */
8137 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8140 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8141 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8142 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8143 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8144 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8146 void
8147 x_set_offset (f, xoff, yoff, change_gravity)
8148 struct frame *f;
8149 register int xoff, yoff;
8150 int change_gravity;
8152 int modified_top, modified_left;
8154 if (change_gravity > 0)
8156 f->top_pos = yoff;
8157 f->left_pos = xoff;
8158 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8159 if (xoff < 0)
8160 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8161 if (yoff < 0)
8162 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8163 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8165 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8167 BLOCK_INPUT;
8168 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8170 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8171 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8173 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8175 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8176 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8177 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8178 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8179 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8182 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8183 modified_left, modified_top);
8185 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
8186 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN)
8188 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->check_expected_move = 1;
8189 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_top = f->top_pos;
8190 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_left = f->left_pos;
8193 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8196 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8197 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8198 static void
8199 x_check_fullscreen (f)
8200 struct frame *f;
8202 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8204 int width, height, ign;
8206 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
8208 x_fullscreen_adjust (f, &width, &height, &ign, &ign);
8210 /* We do not need to move the window, it shall be taken care of
8211 when setting WM manager hints.
8212 If the frame is visible already, the position is checked by
8213 x_check_expected_move. */
8214 if (FRAME_COLS (f) != width || FRAME_LINES (f) != height)
8216 change_frame_size (f, height, width, 0, 1, 0);
8217 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8218 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8220 /* Wait for the change of frame size to occur */
8221 f->want_fullscreen |= FULLSCREEN_WAIT;
8226 /* If frame parameters are set after the frame is mapped, we need to move
8227 the window.
8228 Some window managers moves the window to the right position, some
8229 moves the outer window manager window to the specified position.
8230 Here we check that we are in the right spot. If not, make a second
8231 move, assuming we are dealing with the second kind of window manager. */
8232 static void
8233 x_check_expected_move (f)
8234 struct frame *f;
8236 if (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->check_expected_move)
8238 int expect_top = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_top;
8239 int expect_left = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_left;
8241 if (expect_top != f->top_pos || expect_left != f->left_pos)
8243 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8244 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expect_left - f->left_pos;
8245 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expect_top - f->top_pos;
8247 f->left_pos = expect_left;
8248 f->top_pos = expect_top;
8249 x_set_offset (f, expect_left, expect_top, 0);
8251 else if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN)
8252 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8254 /* Just do this once */
8255 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->check_expected_move = 0;
8260 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8261 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8262 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8263 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8265 static void
8266 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
8267 struct frame *f;
8268 int change_gravity;
8269 int cols, rows;
8271 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8273 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8274 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8275 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8277 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0
8278 ? FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f)
8279 : (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f)));
8281 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8283 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols);
8284 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows);
8286 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8287 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8289 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8290 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8291 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8293 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8294 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8295 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8296 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8298 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8299 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8300 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8301 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8302 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8304 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8305 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8306 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8307 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8308 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8310 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8311 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8312 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8313 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8314 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8316 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8320 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8321 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8322 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8323 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8325 void
8326 x_set_window_size (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
8327 struct frame *f;
8328 int change_gravity;
8329 int cols, rows;
8331 BLOCK_INPUT;
8333 #ifdef USE_GTK
8334 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8335 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8336 else
8337 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8338 #elif USE_X_TOOLKIT
8340 if (f->output_data.x->widget != NULL)
8342 /* The x and y position of the widget is clobbered by the
8343 call to XtSetValues within EmacsFrameSetCharSize.
8344 This is a real kludge, but I don't understand Xt so I can't
8345 figure out a correct fix. Can anyone else tell me? -- rms. */
8346 int xpos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.x;
8347 int ypos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.y;
8348 EmacsFrameSetCharSize (f->output_data.x->edit_widget, cols, rows);
8349 f->output_data.x->widget->core.x = xpos;
8350 f->output_data.x->widget->core.y = ypos;
8352 else
8353 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8355 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8357 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8359 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8361 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8362 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8364 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8365 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8366 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8367 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8368 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8370 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8373 /* Mouse warping. */
8375 void
8376 x_set_mouse_position (f, x, y)
8377 struct frame *f;
8378 int x, y;
8380 int pix_x, pix_y;
8382 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8383 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8385 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8386 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8388 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8389 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8391 BLOCK_INPUT;
8393 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8394 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8395 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8398 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8400 void
8401 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (f, pix_x, pix_y)
8402 struct frame *f;
8403 int pix_x, pix_y;
8405 BLOCK_INPUT;
8407 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8408 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8409 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8412 /* focus shifting, raising and lowering. */
8414 void
8415 x_focus_on_frame (f)
8416 struct frame *f;
8418 #if 0 /* This proves to be unpleasant. */
8419 x_raise_frame (f);
8420 #endif
8421 #if 0
8422 /* I don't think that the ICCCM allows programs to do things like this
8423 without the interaction of the window manager. Whatever you end up
8424 doing with this code, do it to x_unfocus_frame too. */
8425 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8426 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8427 #endif /* ! 0 */
8430 void
8431 x_unfocus_frame (f)
8432 struct frame *f;
8434 #if 0
8435 /* Look at the remarks in x_focus_on_frame. */
8436 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_focus_frame == f)
8437 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), PointerRoot,
8438 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8439 #endif /* ! 0 */
8442 /* Raise frame F. */
8444 void
8445 x_raise_frame (f)
8446 struct frame *f;
8448 if (f->async_visible)
8450 BLOCK_INPUT;
8451 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8452 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8453 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8457 /* Lower frame F. */
8459 void
8460 x_lower_frame (f)
8461 struct frame *f;
8463 if (f->async_visible)
8465 BLOCK_INPUT;
8466 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8467 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8468 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8472 static void
8473 XTframe_raise_lower (f, raise_flag)
8474 FRAME_PTR f;
8475 int raise_flag;
8477 if (raise_flag)
8478 x_raise_frame (f);
8479 else
8480 x_lower_frame (f);
8483 /* Change of visibility. */
8485 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
8486 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
8487 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
8488 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
8489 but it will become visible later when the window manager
8490 finishes with it. */
8492 void
8493 x_make_frame_visible (f)
8494 struct frame *f;
8496 Lisp_Object type;
8497 int original_top, original_left;
8498 int retry_count = 2;
8500 retry:
8502 BLOCK_INPUT;
8504 type = x_icon_type (f);
8505 if (!NILP (type))
8506 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
8508 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8510 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
8511 call x_set_offset a second time
8512 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
8513 before the window gets really visible. */
8514 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8515 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
8516 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
8518 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
8520 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8521 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
8522 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8523 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
8524 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8525 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8526 #ifdef USE_GTK
8527 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8528 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
8529 #else
8530 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8531 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8532 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8533 #if 0 /* This seems to bring back scroll bars in the wrong places
8534 if the window configuration has changed. They seem
8535 to come back ok without this. */
8536 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
8537 XMapSubwindows (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8538 #endif
8541 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8543 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
8544 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
8545 so that incoming events are handled. */
8547 Lisp_Object frame;
8548 int count;
8549 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
8550 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
8551 will set it when they are handled. */
8552 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
8554 original_left = f->left_pos;
8555 original_top = f->top_pos;
8557 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
8558 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8560 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
8562 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
8563 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
8564 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
8565 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
8567 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
8568 because the window manager may choose the position
8569 and we don't want to override it. */
8571 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8572 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
8573 && previously_visible)
8575 Drawable rootw;
8576 int x, y;
8577 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
8579 BLOCK_INPUT;
8581 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
8582 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
8583 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
8584 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
8585 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
8586 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
8587 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
8588 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8589 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
8591 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
8592 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8593 original_left, original_top);
8595 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8598 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8600 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
8601 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
8602 MapNotify at all.. */
8603 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
8604 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
8606 /* Force processing of queued events. */
8607 x_sync (f);
8609 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
8610 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
8611 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
8612 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
8613 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
8614 probably a bug. */
8615 if (input_polling_used ())
8617 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
8618 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
8619 handler reset it. */
8620 extern void poll_for_input_1 P_ ((void));
8621 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
8622 poll_suppress_count = 1;
8623 poll_for_input_1 ();
8624 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
8627 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
8628 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
8631 /* 2000-09-28: In
8633 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
8634 (iconify-frame f)
8635 (raise-frame f))
8637 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
8638 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
8639 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
8640 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
8642 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count > 0)
8643 goto retry;
8647 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
8649 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
8651 void
8652 x_make_frame_invisible (f)
8653 struct frame *f;
8655 Window window;
8657 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
8658 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
8660 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
8661 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
8662 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
8664 #if 0/* This might add unreliability; I don't trust it -- rms. */
8665 if (! f->async_visible && ! f->async_iconified)
8666 return;
8667 #endif
8669 BLOCK_INPUT;
8671 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
8672 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
8673 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
8674 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
8675 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
8676 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
8678 #ifdef USE_GTK
8679 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
8680 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8681 else
8682 #endif
8684 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
8686 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
8687 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
8689 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8690 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
8692 #else /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
8694 /* Tell the window manager what we're going to do. */
8695 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8697 XEvent unmap;
8699 unmap.xunmap.type = UnmapNotify;
8700 unmap.xunmap.window = window;
8701 unmap.xunmap.event = DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8702 unmap.xunmap.from_configure = False;
8703 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8704 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
8705 False,
8706 SubstructureRedirectMaskSubstructureNotifyMask,
8707 &unmap))
8709 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8710 error ("Can't notify window manager of withdrawal");
8714 /* Unmap the window ourselves. Cheeky! */
8715 XUnmapWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window);
8716 #endif /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
8719 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
8720 just by the event that we get from the server.
8721 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
8722 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
8723 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
8724 f->visible = 0;
8725 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
8726 f->async_visible = 0;
8727 f->async_iconified = 0;
8729 x_sync (f);
8731 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8734 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
8736 void
8737 x_iconify_frame (f)
8738 struct frame *f;
8740 int result;
8741 Lisp_Object type;
8743 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
8744 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
8745 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
8747 if (f->async_iconified)
8748 return;
8750 BLOCK_INPUT;
8752 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
8754 type = x_icon_type (f);
8755 if (!NILP (type))
8756 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
8758 #ifdef USE_GTK
8759 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
8761 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8762 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8764 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
8765 f->iconified = 1;
8766 f->visible = 1;
8767 f->async_iconified = 1;
8768 f->async_visible = 0;
8769 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8770 return;
8772 #endif
8774 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8776 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8778 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8779 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
8780 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
8781 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8782 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
8783 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
8784 so we have to record it here. */
8785 f->iconified = 1;
8786 f->visible = 1;
8787 f->async_iconified = 1;
8788 f->async_visible = 0;
8789 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8790 return;
8793 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8794 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
8795 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
8796 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8798 if (!result)
8799 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
8801 f->async_iconified = 1;
8802 f->async_visible = 0;
8805 BLOCK_INPUT;
8806 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8807 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8808 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8810 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
8811 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
8812 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && !FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
8813 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
8815 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
8816 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
8818 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
8819 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
8821 XEvent message;
8823 message.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
8824 message.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
8825 message.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
8826 message.xclient.format = 32;
8827 message.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
8829 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8830 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
8831 False,
8832 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
8833 &message))
8835 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8836 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
8840 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
8841 IconicState. */
8842 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
8844 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8846 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
8847 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8850 f->async_iconified = 1;
8851 f->async_visible = 0;
8853 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8854 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8855 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8859 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
8861 void
8862 x_free_frame_resources (f)
8863 struct frame *f;
8865 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8866 Lisp_Object bar;
8867 struct scroll_bar *b;
8869 BLOCK_INPUT;
8871 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
8872 commands to the X server. */
8873 if (dpyinfo->display)
8875 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
8876 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
8878 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8879 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
8880 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
8881 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
8882 toolkit scroll bars. */
8883 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
8885 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
8886 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
8888 #endif
8890 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8891 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
8892 free_frame_xic (f);
8893 #endif
8895 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8896 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
8898 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8899 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
8901 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
8902 we are using a toolkit. */
8903 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
8904 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8906 free_frame_menubar (f);
8907 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8909 #ifdef USE_GTK
8910 /* In the GTK version, tooltips are normal X
8911 frames. We must check and free both types. */
8912 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
8914 gtk_widget_destroy (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8915 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) = 0; /* Set to avoid XDestroyWindow below */
8916 FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f) = 0;
8918 #endif /* USE_GTK */
8920 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
8921 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8922 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8924 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
8925 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
8926 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
8927 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
8928 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
8929 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
8931 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
8932 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
8933 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
8934 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
8935 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
8936 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
8937 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
8938 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
8939 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
8940 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
8941 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
8942 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
8943 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
8944 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
8945 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
8947 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
8948 free_frame_faces (f);
8950 x_free_gcs (f);
8951 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8954 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event)
8955 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
8957 xfree (f->output_data.x);
8958 f->output_data.x = NULL;
8960 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
8961 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
8962 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
8963 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
8964 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
8965 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
8967 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
8969 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
8970 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
8971 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
8972 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
8973 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
8974 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
8975 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
8978 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8982 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
8984 void
8985 x_destroy_window (f)
8986 struct frame *f;
8988 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8990 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
8991 commands to the X server. */
8992 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
8993 x_free_frame_resources (f);
8995 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
8999 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9001 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9002 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9003 that the window now has.
9004 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9005 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9006 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9008 #ifndef USE_GTK
9009 void
9010 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, flags, user_position)
9011 struct frame *f;
9012 long flags;
9013 int user_position;
9015 XSizeHints size_hints;
9017 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9018 Arg al[2];
9019 int ac = 0;
9020 Dimension widget_width, widget_height;
9021 #endif
9023 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9025 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9026 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9028 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9029 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9031 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9032 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNwidth, &widget_width); ac++;
9033 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNheight, &widget_height); ac++;
9034 XtGetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, ac);
9035 size_hints.height = widget_height;
9036 size_hints.width = widget_width;
9037 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9038 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9039 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9040 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9042 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9043 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9044 size_hints.max_width
9045 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9046 size_hints.max_height
9047 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9049 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes.
9051 (When we use the X toolkit, we don't do it here.
9052 Instead we copy the values that the widgets are using, below.) */
9053 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9055 int base_width, base_height;
9056 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9058 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9059 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9061 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9063 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9064 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9065 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9066 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9067 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9069 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9070 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9071 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9073 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9074 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9075 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9076 size_hints.base_height = base_height;
9077 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9078 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9079 #else
9080 size_hints.min_width = base_width;
9081 size_hints.min_height = base_height;
9082 #endif
9085 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9086 if (flags)
9088 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9089 goto no_read;
9091 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9094 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9095 long supplied_return;
9096 int value;
9098 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9099 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9100 &supplied_return);
9101 #else
9102 value = XGetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints);
9103 #endif
9105 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9106 size_hints.base_height = hints.base_height;
9107 size_hints.base_width = hints.base_width;
9108 size_hints.min_height = hints.min_height;
9109 size_hints.min_width = hints.min_width;
9110 #endif
9112 if (flags)
9113 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9114 else
9116 if (value == 0)
9117 hints.flags = 0;
9118 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9119 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9120 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9121 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9122 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9123 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9124 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9125 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9129 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9130 no_read:
9131 #endif
9133 #ifdef PWinGravity
9134 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9135 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9137 if (user_position)
9139 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9140 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9142 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9144 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9145 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9146 #else
9147 XSetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9148 #endif
9150 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9152 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9154 void
9155 x_wm_set_window_state (f, state)
9156 struct frame *f;
9157 int state;
9159 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9160 Arg al[1];
9162 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9163 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9164 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9165 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9167 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9168 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9170 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9171 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9174 void
9175 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, pixmap_id)
9176 struct frame *f;
9177 int pixmap_id;
9179 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9181 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9182 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9183 #endif
9185 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9187 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9188 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9189 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9190 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9192 else
9194 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon pixmap.
9195 The following line does it, only if no icon has yet been created,
9196 for some window managers. But with mwm it crashes.
9197 Some people say it should clear the IconPixmapHint bit in this case,
9198 but that doesn't work, and the X consortium said it isn't the
9199 right thing at all. Since there is no way to win,
9200 best to explicitly give up. */
9201 #if 0
9202 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = None;
9203 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = None;
9204 #else
9205 return;
9206 #endif
9210 #ifdef USE_GTK
9212 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
9213 return;
9216 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9219 Arg al[1];
9220 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9221 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9222 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9223 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9226 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9228 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9229 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9231 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9234 void
9235 x_wm_set_icon_position (f, icon_x, icon_y)
9236 struct frame *f;
9237 int icon_x, icon_y;
9239 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9241 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9242 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9243 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9245 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9249 /***********************************************************************
9250 Fonts
9251 ***********************************************************************/
9253 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of font FONT_IDX of frame F. */
9255 struct font_info *
9256 x_get_font_info (f, font_idx)
9257 FRAME_PTR f;
9258 int font_idx;
9260 return (FRAME_X_FONT_TABLE (f) + font_idx);
9264 /* Return a list of names of available fonts matching PATTERN on frame F.
9266 If SIZE is > 0, it is the size (maximum bounds width) of fonts
9267 to be listed.
9269 SIZE < 0 means include scalable fonts.
9271 Frame F null means we have not yet created any frame on X, and
9272 consult the first display in x_display_list. MAXNAMES sets a limit
9273 on how many fonts to match. */
9275 Lisp_Object
9276 x_list_fonts (f, pattern, size, maxnames)
9277 struct frame *f;
9278 Lisp_Object pattern;
9279 int size;
9280 int maxnames;
9282 Lisp_Object list = Qnil, patterns, newlist = Qnil, key = Qnil;
9283 Lisp_Object tem, second_best;
9284 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo
9285 = f ? FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) : x_display_list;
9286 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
9287 int try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9288 int count;
9289 int allow_auto_scaled_font = 0;
9291 if (size < 0)
9293 allow_auto_scaled_font = 1;
9294 size = 0;
9297 patterns = Fassoc (pattern, Valternate_fontname_alist);
9298 if (NILP (patterns))
9299 patterns = Fcons (pattern, Qnil);
9301 if (maxnames == 1 && !size)
9302 /* We can return any single font matching PATTERN. */
9303 try_XLoadQueryFont = 1;
9305 for (; CONSP (patterns); patterns = XCDR (patterns))
9307 int num_fonts;
9308 char **names = NULL;
9310 pattern = XCAR (patterns);
9311 /* See if we cached the result for this particular query.
9312 The cache is an alist of the form:
9313 ((((PATTERN . MAXNAMES) . SCALABLE) (FONTNAME . WIDTH) ...) ...) */
9314 tem = XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element);
9315 key = Fcons (Fcons (pattern, make_number (maxnames)),
9316 allow_auto_scaled_font ? Qt : Qnil);
9317 list = Fassoc (key, tem);
9318 if (!NILP (list))
9320 list = Fcdr_safe (list);
9321 /* We have a cashed list. Don't have to get the list again. */
9322 goto label_cached;
9325 /* At first, put PATTERN in the cache. */
9327 BLOCK_INPUT;
9328 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
9330 if (try_XLoadQueryFont)
9332 XFontStruct *font;
9333 unsigned long value;
9335 font = XLoadQueryFont (dpy, SDATA (pattern));
9336 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9338 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9339 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9340 font = NULL;
9341 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9344 if (font
9345 && XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
9347 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (dpy, (Atom) value);
9348 int len = strlen (name);
9349 char *tmp;
9351 /* If DXPC (a Differential X Protocol Compressor)
9352 Ver.3.7 is running, XGetAtomName will return null
9353 string. We must avoid such a name. */
9354 if (len == 0)
9355 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9356 else
9358 num_fonts = 1;
9359 names = (char **) alloca (sizeof (char *));
9360 /* Some systems only allow alloca assigned to a
9361 simple var. */
9362 tmp = (char *) alloca (len + 1); names[0] = tmp;
9363 bcopy (name, names[0], len + 1);
9364 XFree (name);
9367 else
9368 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9370 if (font)
9371 XFreeFont (dpy, font);
9374 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
9376 /* We try at least 10 fonts because XListFonts will return
9377 auto-scaled fonts at the head. */
9378 if (maxnames < 0)
9380 int limit;
9382 for (limit = 500;;)
9384 names = XListFonts (dpy, SDATA (pattern), limit, &num_fonts);
9385 if (num_fonts == limit)
9387 BLOCK_INPUT;
9388 XFreeFontNames (names);
9389 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9390 limit *= 2;
9392 else
9393 break;
9396 else
9397 names = XListFonts (dpy, SDATA (pattern), max (maxnames, 10),
9398 &num_fonts);
9400 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9402 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9403 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9404 names = NULL;
9405 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9409 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
9410 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9412 if (names)
9414 int i;
9416 /* Make a list of all the fonts we got back.
9417 Store that in the font cache for the display. */
9418 for (i = 0; i < num_fonts; i++)
9420 int width = 0;
9421 char *p = names[i];
9422 int average_width = -1, resx = 0, dashes = 0;
9424 /* Count the number of dashes in NAMES[I]. If there are
9425 14 dashes, the field value following 9th dash
9426 (RESOLUTION_X) is nonzero, and the field value
9427 following 12th dash (AVERAGE_WIDTH) is 0, this is a
9428 auto-scaled font which is usually too ugly to be used
9429 for editing. Let's ignore it. */
9430 while (*p)
9431 if (*p++ == '-')
9433 dashes++;
9434 if (dashes == 7) /* PIXEL_SIZE field */
9435 width = atoi (p);
9436 else if (dashes == 9)
9437 resx = atoi (p);
9438 else if (dashes == 12) /* AVERAGE_WIDTH field */
9439 average_width = atoi (p);
9442 if (allow_auto_scaled_font
9443 || dashes < 14 || average_width != 0 || resx == 0)
9445 tem = build_string (names[i]);
9446 if (NILP (Fassoc (tem, list)))
9448 if (STRINGP (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp)
9449 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case
9450 (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp, names[i]))
9451 >= 0))
9452 /* We can set the value of PIXEL_SIZE to the
9453 width of this font. */
9454 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, make_number (width)), list);
9455 else
9456 /* For the moment, width is not known. */
9457 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, Qnil), list);
9462 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
9464 BLOCK_INPUT;
9465 XFreeFontNames (names);
9466 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9470 /* Now store the result in the cache. */
9471 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9472 Fcons (Fcons (key, list), XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9474 label_cached:
9475 if (NILP (list)) continue; /* Try the remaining alternatives. */
9477 newlist = second_best = Qnil;
9478 /* Make a list of the fonts that have the right width. */
9479 for (; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
9481 int found_size;
9483 tem = XCAR (list);
9485 if (!CONSP (tem) || NILP (XCAR (tem)))
9486 continue;
9487 if (!size)
9489 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
9490 continue;
9493 if (!INTEGERP (XCDR (tem)))
9495 /* Since we have not yet known the size of this font, we
9496 must try slow function call XLoadQueryFont. */
9497 XFontStruct *thisinfo;
9499 BLOCK_INPUT;
9500 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
9501 thisinfo = XLoadQueryFont (dpy,
9502 SDATA (XCAR (tem)));
9503 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9505 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9506 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9507 thisinfo = NULL;
9508 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9510 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
9511 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9513 if (thisinfo)
9515 XSETCDR (tem,
9516 (thisinfo->min_bounds.width == 0
9517 ? make_number (0)
9518 : make_number (thisinfo->max_bounds.width)));
9519 BLOCK_INPUT;
9520 XFreeFont (dpy, thisinfo);
9521 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9523 else
9524 /* For unknown reason, the previous call of XListFont had
9525 returned a font which can't be opened. Record the size
9526 as 0 not to try to open it again. */
9527 XSETCDR (tem, make_number (0));
9530 found_size = XINT (XCDR (tem));
9531 if (found_size == size)
9532 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
9533 else if (found_size > 0)
9535 if (NILP (second_best))
9536 second_best = tem;
9537 else if (found_size < size)
9539 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
9540 || XINT (XCDR (second_best)) < found_size)
9541 second_best = tem;
9543 else
9545 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
9546 && XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > found_size)
9547 second_best = tem;
9551 if (!NILP (newlist))
9552 break;
9553 else if (!NILP (second_best))
9555 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (second_best), Qnil);
9556 break;
9560 return newlist;
9564 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
9566 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9567 font table. */
9569 static void
9570 x_check_font (f, font)
9571 struct frame *f;
9572 XFontStruct *font;
9574 int i;
9575 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9577 xassert (font != NULL);
9579 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9580 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9581 && font == dpyinfo->font_table[i].font)
9582 break;
9584 xassert (i < dpyinfo->n_fonts);
9587 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
9589 /* Set *W to the minimum width, *H to the minimum font height of FONT.
9590 Note: There are (broken) X fonts out there with invalid XFontStruct
9591 min_bounds contents. For example, handa@etl.go.jp reports that
9592 "-adobe-courier-medium-r-normal--*-180-*-*-m-*-iso8859-1" fonts
9593 have font->min_bounds.width == 0. */
9595 static INLINE void
9596 x_font_min_bounds (font, w, h)
9597 XFontStruct *font;
9598 int *w, *h;
9600 *h = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
9601 *w = font->min_bounds.width;
9603 /* Try to handle the case where FONT->min_bounds has invalid
9604 contents. Since the only font known to have invalid min_bounds
9605 is fixed-width, use max_bounds if min_bounds seems to be invalid. */
9606 if (*w <= 0)
9607 *w = font->max_bounds.width;
9611 /* Compute the smallest character width and smallest font height over
9612 all fonts available on frame F. Set the members smallest_char_width
9613 and smallest_font_height in F's x_display_info structure to
9614 the values computed. Value is non-zero if smallest_font_height or
9615 smallest_char_width become smaller than they were before. */
9617 static int
9618 x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f)
9619 struct frame *f;
9621 int i;
9622 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9623 XFontStruct *font;
9624 int old_width = dpyinfo->smallest_char_width;
9625 int old_height = dpyinfo->smallest_font_height;
9627 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = 100000;
9628 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = 100000;
9630 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
9631 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
9633 struct font_info *fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
9634 int w, h;
9636 font = (XFontStruct *) fontp->font;
9637 xassert (font != (XFontStruct *) ~0);
9638 x_font_min_bounds (font, &w, &h);
9640 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = min (dpyinfo->smallest_font_height, h);
9641 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = min (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width, w);
9644 xassert (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width > 0
9645 && dpyinfo->smallest_font_height > 0);
9647 return (dpyinfo->n_fonts == 1
9648 || dpyinfo->smallest_char_width < old_width
9649 || dpyinfo->smallest_font_height < old_height);
9653 /* Load font named FONTNAME of the size SIZE for frame F, and return a
9654 pointer to the structure font_info while allocating it dynamically.
9655 If SIZE is 0, load any size of font.
9656 If loading is failed, return NULL. */
9658 struct font_info *
9659 x_load_font (f, fontname, size)
9660 struct frame *f;
9661 register char *fontname;
9662 int size;
9664 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9665 Lisp_Object font_names;
9666 int count;
9668 /* Get a list of all the fonts that match this name. Once we
9669 have a list of matching fonts, we compare them against the fonts
9670 we already have by comparing names. */
9671 font_names = x_list_fonts (f, build_string (fontname), size, 1);
9673 if (!NILP (font_names))
9675 Lisp_Object tail;
9676 int i;
9678 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9679 for (tail = font_names; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
9680 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9681 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name,
9682 SDATA (XCAR (tail)))
9683 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name,
9684 SDATA (XCAR (tail)))))
9685 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
9688 /* Load the font and add it to the table. */
9690 char *full_name;
9691 XFontStruct *font;
9692 struct font_info *fontp;
9693 unsigned long value;
9694 int i;
9696 /* If we have found fonts by x_list_font, load one of them. If
9697 not, we still try to load a font by the name given as FONTNAME
9698 because XListFonts (called in x_list_font) of some X server has
9699 a bug of not finding a font even if the font surely exists and
9700 is loadable by XLoadQueryFont. */
9701 if (size > 0 && !NILP (font_names))
9702 fontname = (char *) SDATA (XCAR (font_names));
9704 BLOCK_INPUT;
9705 count = x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9706 font = (XFontStruct *) XLoadQueryFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), fontname);
9707 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)))
9709 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9710 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9711 font = NULL;
9712 x_clear_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9714 x_uncatch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), count);
9715 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9716 if (!font)
9717 return NULL;
9719 /* Find a free slot in the font table. */
9720 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
9721 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name == NULL)
9722 break;
9724 /* If no free slot found, maybe enlarge the font table. */
9725 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts
9726 && dpyinfo->n_fonts == dpyinfo->font_table_size)
9728 int sz;
9729 dpyinfo->font_table_size = max (16, 2 * dpyinfo->font_table_size);
9730 sz = dpyinfo->font_table_size * sizeof *dpyinfo->font_table;
9731 dpyinfo->font_table
9732 = (struct font_info *) xrealloc (dpyinfo->font_table, sz);
9735 fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
9736 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts)
9737 ++dpyinfo->n_fonts;
9739 /* Now fill in the slots of *FONTP. */
9740 BLOCK_INPUT;
9741 bzero (fontp, sizeof (*fontp));
9742 fontp->font = font;
9743 fontp->font_idx = i;
9744 fontp->name = (char *) xmalloc (strlen (fontname) + 1);
9745 bcopy (fontname, fontp->name, strlen (fontname) + 1);
9747 if (font->min_bounds.width == font->max_bounds.width)
9749 /* Fixed width font. */
9750 fontp->average_width = fontp->space_width = font->min_bounds.width;
9752 else
9754 XChar2b char2b;
9755 XCharStruct *pcm;
9757 char2b.byte1 = 0x00, char2b.byte2 = 0x20;
9758 pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b, 0);
9759 if (pcm)
9760 fontp->space_width = pcm->width;
9761 else
9762 fontp->space_width = FONT_WIDTH (font);
9764 fontp->average_width
9765 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH, &value)
9766 ? (long) value / 10 : 0);
9767 if (fontp->average_width < 0)
9768 fontp->average_width = - fontp->average_width;
9769 if (fontp->average_width == 0)
9771 if (pcm)
9773 int width = pcm->width;
9774 for (char2b.byte2 = 33; char2b.byte2 <= 126; char2b.byte2++)
9775 if ((pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b, 0)) != NULL)
9776 width += pcm->width;
9777 fontp->average_width = width / 95;
9779 else
9780 fontp->average_width = FONT_WIDTH (font);
9784 /* Try to get the full name of FONT. Put it in FULL_NAME. */
9785 full_name = 0;
9786 if (XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
9788 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), (Atom) value);
9789 char *p = name;
9790 int dashes = 0;
9792 /* Count the number of dashes in the "full name".
9793 If it is too few, this isn't really the font's full name,
9794 so don't use it.
9795 In X11R4, the fonts did not come with their canonical names
9796 stored in them. */
9797 while (*p)
9799 if (*p == '-')
9800 dashes++;
9801 p++;
9804 if (dashes >= 13)
9806 full_name = (char *) xmalloc (p - name + 1);
9807 bcopy (name, full_name, p - name + 1);
9810 XFree (name);
9813 if (full_name != 0)
9814 fontp->full_name = full_name;
9815 else
9816 fontp->full_name = fontp->name;
9818 fontp->size = font->max_bounds.width;
9819 fontp->height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
9821 if (NILP (font_names))
9823 /* We come here because of a bug of XListFonts mentioned at
9824 the head of this block. Let's store this information in
9825 the cache for x_list_fonts. */
9826 Lisp_Object lispy_name = build_string (fontname);
9827 Lisp_Object lispy_full_name = build_string (fontp->full_name);
9828 Lisp_Object key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_name, make_number (256)),
9829 Qnil);
9831 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9832 Fcons (Fcons (key,
9833 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
9834 make_number (fontp->size)),
9835 Qnil)),
9836 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9837 if (full_name)
9839 key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name, make_number (256)),
9840 Qnil);
9841 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9842 Fcons (Fcons (key,
9843 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
9844 make_number (fontp->size)),
9845 Qnil)),
9846 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9850 /* The slot `encoding' specifies how to map a character
9851 code-points (0x20..0x7F or 0x2020..0x7F7F) of each charset to
9852 the font code-points (0:0x20..0x7F, 1:0xA0..0xFF), or
9853 (0:0x2020..0x7F7F, 1:0xA0A0..0xFFFF, 3:0x20A0..0x7FFF,
9854 2:0xA020..0xFF7F). For the moment, we don't know which charset
9855 uses this font. So, we set information in fontp->encoding[1]
9856 which is never used by any charset. If mapping can't be
9857 decided, set FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED. */
9858 fontp->encoding[1]
9859 = (font->max_byte1 == 0
9860 /* 1-byte font */
9861 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9862 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9863 ? 0 /* 0x20..0x7F */
9864 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20..0xFF */
9865 : 1) /* 0xA0..0xFF */
9866 /* 2-byte font */
9867 : (font->min_byte1 < 0x80
9868 ? (font->max_byte1 < 0x80
9869 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9870 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9871 ? 0 /* 0x2020..0x7F7F */
9872 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x2020..0x7FFF */
9873 : 3) /* 0x20A0..0x7FFF */
9874 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20??..0xA0?? */
9875 : (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9876 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9877 ? 2 /* 0xA020..0xFF7F */
9878 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0xA020..0xFFFF */
9879 : 1))); /* 0xA0A0..0xFFFF */
9881 fontp->baseline_offset
9882 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET, &value)
9883 ? (long) value : 0);
9884 fontp->relative_compose
9885 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE, &value)
9886 ? (long) value : 0);
9887 fontp->default_ascent
9888 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT, &value)
9889 ? (long) value : 0);
9891 /* Set global flag fonts_changed_p to non-zero if the font loaded
9892 has a character with a smaller width than any other character
9893 before, or if the font loaded has a smaller height than any
9894 other font loaded before. If this happens, it will make a
9895 glyph matrix reallocation necessary. */
9896 fonts_changed_p |= x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f);
9897 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9898 return fontp;
9903 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of a font named FONTNAME for
9904 frame F. If no such font is loaded, return NULL. */
9906 struct font_info *
9907 x_query_font (f, fontname)
9908 struct frame *f;
9909 register char *fontname;
9911 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9912 int i;
9914 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9915 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9916 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name, fontname)
9917 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name, fontname)))
9918 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
9919 return NULL;
9923 /* Find a CCL program for a font specified by FONTP, and set the member
9924 `encoder' of the structure. */
9926 void
9927 x_find_ccl_program (fontp)
9928 struct font_info *fontp;
9930 Lisp_Object list, elt;
9932 elt = Qnil;
9933 for (list = Vfont_ccl_encoder_alist; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
9935 elt = XCAR (list);
9936 if (CONSP (elt)
9937 && STRINGP (XCAR (elt))
9938 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->name)
9939 >= 0)
9940 || (fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->full_name)
9941 >= 0)))
9942 break;
9945 if (! NILP (list))
9947 struct ccl_program *ccl
9948 = (struct ccl_program *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct ccl_program));
9950 if (setup_ccl_program (ccl, XCDR (elt)) < 0)
9951 xfree (ccl);
9952 else
9953 fontp->font_encoder = ccl;
9959 /***********************************************************************
9960 Initialization
9961 ***********************************************************************/
9963 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9964 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
9965 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9966 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
9968 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
9969 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9970 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9972 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9973 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9974 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9975 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9976 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9977 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9978 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
9980 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9982 static int x_initialized;
9984 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
9985 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
9986 the screen number from the server number. */
9987 static int
9988 same_x_server (name1, name2)
9989 const char *name1, *name2;
9991 int seen_colon = 0;
9992 const unsigned char *system_name = SDATA (Vsystem_name);
9993 int system_name_length = strlen (system_name);
9994 int length_until_period = 0;
9996 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
9997 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
9998 length_until_period++;
10000 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
10001 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
10002 name1 += 4;
10003 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
10004 name2 += 4;
10005 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
10006 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
10007 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
10008 name1 += system_name_length;
10009 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
10010 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
10011 name2 += system_name_length;
10012 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
10013 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
10014 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
10015 name1 += length_until_period;
10016 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
10017 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
10018 name2 += length_until_period;
10020 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
10022 if (*name1 == ':')
10023 seen_colon++;
10024 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
10025 return 1;
10027 return (seen_colon
10028 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
10029 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
10031 #endif
10033 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
10034 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
10035 to 5. */
10036 static void
10037 get_bits_and_offset (mask, bits, offset)
10038 unsigned long mask;
10039 int *bits;
10040 int *offset;
10042 int nr = 0;
10043 int off = 0;
10045 while (!(mask & 1))
10047 off++;
10048 mask >>= 1;
10051 while (mask & 1)
10053 nr++;
10054 mask >>= 1;
10057 *offset = off;
10058 *bits = nr;
10061 struct x_display_info *
10062 x_term_init (display_name, xrm_option, resource_name)
10063 Lisp_Object display_name;
10064 char *xrm_option;
10065 char *resource_name;
10067 int connection;
10068 Display *dpy;
10069 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
10070 XrmDatabase xrdb;
10072 BLOCK_INPUT;
10074 if (!x_initialized)
10076 x_initialize ();
10077 ++x_initialized;
10080 #ifdef USE_GTK
10082 #define NUM_ARGV 10
10083 int argc;
10084 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
10085 char **argv2 = argv;
10086 GdkAtom atom;
10088 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
10090 /* Opening another display. If xg_display_open returns less
10091 than zero, we are probably on GTK 2.0, which can only handle
10092 one display. GTK 2.2 or later can handle more than one. */
10093 if (xg_display_open (SDATA (display_name), &dpy) < 0)
10094 error ("Sorry, this version of GTK can only handle one display");
10096 else
10098 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
10099 argv[argc] = 0;
10101 argc = 0;
10102 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
10104 if (! NILP (display_name))
10106 argv[argc++] = "--display";
10107 argv[argc++] = SDATA (display_name);
10110 argv[argc++] = "--name";
10111 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
10113 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5
10114 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10115 #endif
10117 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
10119 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
10120 fixup_locale ();
10121 xg_initialize ();
10123 dpy = GDK_DISPLAY ();
10125 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function */
10126 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
10128 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
10130 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2;
10131 char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
10132 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
10134 GCPRO2 (s, abs_file);
10135 s = make_string (file, strlen (file));
10136 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
10138 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
10139 gtk_rc_parse (SDATA (abs_file));
10141 UNGCPRO;
10144 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10145 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10148 #else /* not USE_GTK */
10149 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10150 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
10151 errors with X11R5:
10152 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
10153 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
10154 So let's not use it until R6. */
10155 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10156 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
10157 #endif
10160 int argc = 0;
10161 char *argv[3];
10163 argv[0] = "";
10164 argc = 1;
10165 if (xrm_option)
10167 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
10168 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
10170 turn_on_atimers (0);
10171 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SDATA (display_name),
10172 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
10173 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
10174 &argc, argv);
10175 turn_on_atimers (1);
10177 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10178 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
10179 fixup_locale ();
10180 #endif
10183 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10184 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5
10185 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10186 #endif
10187 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SDATA (display_name));
10188 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10189 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
10191 /* Detect failure. */
10192 if (dpy == 0)
10194 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10195 return 0;
10198 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
10200 dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info));
10201 bzero (dpyinfo, sizeof *dpyinfo);
10203 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10205 struct x_display_info *share;
10206 Lisp_Object tail;
10208 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
10209 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
10210 if (same_x_server (SDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
10211 SDATA (display_name)))
10212 break;
10213 if (share)
10214 dpyinfo->kboard = share->kboard;
10215 else
10217 dpyinfo->kboard = (KBOARD *) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD));
10218 init_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
10219 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10221 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10222 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10223 dpyinfo->kboard->Vsystem_key_alist
10224 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10225 build_string (vendor ? vendor : ""));
10226 BLOCK_INPUT;
10229 dpyinfo->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10230 all_kboards = dpyinfo->kboard;
10231 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10232 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10233 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10234 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10235 current_kboard = dpyinfo->kboard;
10237 dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count++;
10239 #endif
10241 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10242 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10243 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10245 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10246 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10247 x_display_name_list);
10248 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10250 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10252 #if 0
10253 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10254 #endif /* ! 0 */
10256 dpyinfo->x_id_name
10257 = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10258 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name)
10259 + 2);
10260 sprintf (dpyinfo->x_id_name, "%s@%s",
10261 SDATA (Vinvocation_name), SDATA (Vsystem_name));
10263 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10264 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10266 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10267 #ifdef USE_GTK
10268 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10269 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10270 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10272 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10273 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10275 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10276 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10277 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10278 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10279 #else
10280 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10281 #endif
10282 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10283 all versions. */
10284 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10286 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10287 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10288 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10289 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10290 dpyinfo->height = HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10291 dpyinfo->width = WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10292 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10293 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10294 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10295 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10296 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10297 dpyinfo->font_table = NULL;
10298 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10299 dpyinfo->font_table_size = 0;
10300 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10301 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10302 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10303 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10304 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10305 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
10306 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10307 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10308 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10309 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10310 dpyinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10311 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10312 dpyinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10313 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10314 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10315 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10316 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10317 dpyinfo->image_cache = make_image_cache ();
10318 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10320 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10321 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10322 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10324 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10326 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10327 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10328 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10329 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10330 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10331 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10334 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10335 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10337 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10339 Lisp_Object value;
10340 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10341 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10342 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10343 Qnil, Qnil);
10344 if (STRINGP (value)
10345 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10346 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10347 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10350 else
10351 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10352 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10355 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10356 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10357 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10358 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10359 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10360 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10361 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10362 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10363 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10366 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
10367 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_PROTOCOLS", False);
10368 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus
10369 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", False);
10370 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself
10371 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", False);
10372 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window
10373 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", False);
10374 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state
10375 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CHANGE_STATE", False);
10376 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied
10377 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", False);
10378 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved
10379 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_MOVED", False);
10380 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader
10381 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", False);
10382 dpyinfo->Xatom_editres
10383 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "Editres", False);
10384 dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD
10385 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "CLIPBOARD", False);
10386 dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP
10387 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TIMESTAMP", False);
10388 dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT
10389 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TEXT", False);
10390 dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT
10391 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "COMPOUND_TEXT", False);
10392 dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING
10393 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "UTF8_STRING", False);
10394 dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE
10395 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DELETE", False);
10396 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE
10397 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "MULTIPLE", False);
10398 dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR
10399 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "INCR", False);
10400 dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP
10401 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_EMACS_TMP_", False);
10402 dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS
10403 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TARGETS", False);
10404 dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL
10405 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "NULL", False);
10406 dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR
10407 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "ATOM_PAIR", False);
10408 /* For properties of font. */
10409 dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE
10410 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PIXEL_SIZE", False);
10411 dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH
10412 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "AVERAGE_WIDTH", False);
10413 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET
10414 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", False);
10415 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE
10416 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", False);
10417 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT
10418 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", False);
10420 /* Ghostscript support. */
10421 dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PAGE", False);
10422 dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DONE", False);
10424 dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "SCROLLBAR",
10425 False);
10427 dpyinfo->cut_buffers_initialized = 0;
10429 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10430 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10433 char null_bits[1];
10435 null_bits[0] = 0x00;
10437 dpyinfo->null_pixel
10438 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10439 null_bits, 1, 1, (long) 0, (long) 0,
10444 extern int gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height;
10445 extern char *gray_bitmap_bits;
10446 dpyinfo->gray
10447 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10448 gray_bitmap_bits,
10449 gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height,
10450 (unsigned long) 1, (unsigned long) 0, 1);
10453 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10454 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10455 #endif
10457 #ifdef subprocesses
10458 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10459 if (connection != 0)
10460 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10461 #endif
10463 #ifndef F_SETOWN_BUG
10464 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10465 #ifdef F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG
10466 /* stdin is a socket here */
10467 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, -getpid ());
10468 #else /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
10469 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10470 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
10471 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10472 #endif /* F_SETOWN_BUG */
10474 #ifdef SIGIO
10475 if (interrupt_input)
10476 init_sigio (connection);
10477 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
10479 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10480 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5 /* It seems X11R4 lacks XtCvtStringToFont, and XPointer. */
10481 /* Make sure that we have a valid font for dialog boxes
10482 so that Xt does not crash. */
10484 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10485 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10486 Font font;
10487 int count;
10489 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10490 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10491 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10492 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10493 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10494 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10495 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
10496 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10497 abort ();
10498 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10499 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10500 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
10502 #endif
10503 #endif
10505 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10506 for debugging X code. */
10508 Lisp_Object value;
10509 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10510 build_string ("synchronous"),
10511 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10512 Qnil, Qnil);
10513 if (STRINGP (value)
10514 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10515 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10516 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10520 Lisp_Object value;
10521 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10522 build_string ("useXIM"),
10523 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10524 Qnil, Qnil);
10525 #ifdef USE_XIM
10526 if (STRINGP (value)
10527 && (!strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "false")
10528 || !strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "off")))
10529 use_xim = 0;
10530 #else
10531 if (STRINGP (value)
10532 && (!strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "true")
10533 || !strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "on")))
10534 use_xim = 1;
10535 #endif
10538 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10539 /* Only do this for the first display. */
10540 if (x_initialized == 1)
10541 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10542 #endif
10544 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10546 return dpyinfo;
10549 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, assuming all frames are already gone,
10550 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10552 void
10553 x_delete_display (dpyinfo)
10554 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
10556 int i;
10558 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10560 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10561 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10562 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10563 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10564 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10565 else
10567 Lisp_Object tail;
10569 tail = x_display_name_list;
10570 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10572 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10574 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10575 break;
10577 tail = XCDR (tail);
10581 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10582 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10584 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10585 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10586 else
10588 struct x_display_info *tail;
10590 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10591 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10592 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10595 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT /* I'm told Xt does this itself. */
10596 #ifndef AIX /* On AIX, XCloseDisplay calls this. */
10597 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10598 #endif
10599 #endif
10600 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10601 if (--dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count == 0)
10602 delete_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
10603 #endif
10604 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10605 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10606 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10607 #endif
10609 /* Free the font names in the font table. */
10610 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
10611 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
10613 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name != dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name)
10614 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name);
10615 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name);
10618 if (dpyinfo->font_table->font_encoder)
10619 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table->font_encoder);
10621 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table);
10622 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10623 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10624 xfree (dpyinfo);
10627 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10629 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10630 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10631 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10632 that slows us down. */
10634 static void
10635 x_process_timeouts (timer)
10636 struct atimer *timer;
10638 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10640 BLOCK_INPUT;
10641 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10642 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10643 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10647 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10650 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10652 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers[];
10654 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10656 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10657 x_produce_glyphs,
10658 x_write_glyphs,
10659 x_insert_glyphs,
10660 x_clear_end_of_line,
10661 x_scroll_run,
10662 x_after_update_window_line,
10663 x_update_window_begin,
10664 x_update_window_end,
10665 x_cursor_to,
10666 x_flush,
10667 #ifdef XFlush
10668 x_flush,
10669 #else
10670 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10671 #endif
10672 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10673 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10674 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10675 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10676 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10677 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10678 x_per_char_metric,
10679 x_encode_char,
10680 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10681 x_draw_glyph_string,
10682 x_define_frame_cursor,
10683 x_clear_frame_area,
10684 x_draw_window_cursor,
10685 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10686 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10689 void
10690 x_initialize ()
10692 rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10694 clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10695 ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10696 delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10697 ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10698 reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10699 set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10700 update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10701 update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10702 set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10703 read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10704 frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10705 mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10706 frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10707 frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10708 set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10709 condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10710 redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10711 judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10713 scroll_region_ok = 1; /* we'll scroll partial frames */
10714 char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10715 line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* we'll just blt 'em */
10716 fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well */
10717 memory_below_frame = 0; /* we don't remember what scrolls
10718 off the bottom */
10719 baud_rate = 19200;
10721 x_noop_count = 0;
10722 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10723 any_help_event_p = 0;
10724 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
10726 #ifdef USE_GTK
10727 current_count = -1;
10728 #endif
10730 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10731 Fset_input_mode (Qt, Qnil, Qt, Qnil);
10733 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10734 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10736 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10738 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10739 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10740 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10741 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10742 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10743 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10744 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10746 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10748 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10749 every 0.1s. This is necessary because some widget sets use
10750 timeouts internally, for example the LessTif menu bar, or the
10751 Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timouts aren't processed, these
10752 widgets don't behave normally. */
10754 EMACS_TIME interval;
10755 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
10756 start_atimer (ATIMER_CONTINUOUS, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10758 #endif
10760 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10761 #ifndef USE_GTK
10762 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10763 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10764 #endif
10765 #endif
10767 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10768 original error handler. */
10769 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10770 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10772 /* Disable Window Change signals; they are handled by X events. */
10773 #ifdef SIGWINCH
10774 signal (SIGWINCH, SIG_DFL);
10775 #endif /* SIGWINCH */
10777 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
10781 void
10782 syms_of_xterm ()
10784 staticpro (&x_error_message_string);
10785 x_error_message_string = Qnil;
10787 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10788 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10790 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10791 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10793 staticpro (&Qvendor_specific_keysyms);
10794 Qvendor_specific_keysyms = intern ("vendor-specific-keysyms");
10796 staticpro (&Qutf_8);
10797 Qutf_8 = intern ("utf-8");
10798 staticpro (&Qlatin_1);
10799 Qlatin_1 = intern ("latin-1");
10801 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10802 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10804 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10805 &x_use_underline_position_properties,
10806 doc: /* *Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10807 nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10808 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10809 to 4.1, set this to nil. */);
10810 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10812 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10813 &x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
10814 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10815 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10816 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10817 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10818 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10819 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10820 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
10822 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", &Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10823 doc: /* What X toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses.
10824 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use X toolkit scroll bars.
10825 Otherwise, value is a symbol describing the X toolkit. */);
10826 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10827 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10828 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("motif");
10829 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10830 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw3d");
10831 #elif USE_GTK
10832 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("gtk");
10833 #else
10834 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw");
10835 #endif
10836 #else
10837 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10838 #endif
10840 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10841 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10843 Qmodifier_value = intern ("modifier-value");
10844 Qalt = intern ("alt");
10845 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10846 Qhyper = intern ("hyper");
10847 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10848 Qmeta = intern ("meta");
10849 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10850 Qsuper = intern ("super");
10851 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10853 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", &Vx_alt_keysym,
10854 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10855 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10856 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10857 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10858 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10860 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", &Vx_hyper_keysym,
10861 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10862 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10863 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10864 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10865 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10867 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", &Vx_meta_keysym,
10868 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10869 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10870 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10871 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10872 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10874 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", &Vx_super_keysym,
10875 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10876 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10877 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10878 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10879 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10881 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", &Vx_keysym_table,
10882 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10883 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
10884 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10885 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10886 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
10889 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */
10891 /* arch-tag: 6d4e4cb7-abc1-4302-9585-d84dcfb09d0f
10892 (do not change this comment) */